blob: 59bf5577372b9b06174bdc292cc0fc193929a015 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1f973062021-05-14 09:36:37 +02005 version 2.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau446344c2021-08-28 13:46:11 +02007 2021/08/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001028.2.4. HTTPS log format
1038.2.5. Custom log format
1048.2.6. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001058.3. Advanced logging options
1068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1078.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1108.4. Timing events
1118.5. Session state at disconnection
1128.6. Non-printable characters
1138.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1158.9. Examples of logs
116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001179. Supported filters
1189.1. Trace
1199.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001209.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001219.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001229.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001239.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
193time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
194are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
199connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
200leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100201start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
202processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
203waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200204
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200205HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100206 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
207 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100208 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200210 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100211
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213
2141.2. HTTP request
215-----------------
216
217First, let's consider this HTTP request :
218
219 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100220 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
222 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
223 3 User-agent: my small browser
224 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
225 5 Accept: image/png
226
227
2281.2.1. The Request line
229-----------------------
230
231Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
232
233 - a METHOD : GET
234 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
236
237All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
238which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
239followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
240is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
241desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
242the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
243
244The URI itself can have several forms :
245
246 - A "relative URI" :
247
248 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
251 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
252
253 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
254
255 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
256
257 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
258 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
259 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
260 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
261 must accept this form too.
262
263 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
264 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
265 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200267 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
268 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
269 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
270 other protocols too.
271
272In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
273mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
274on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
275It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
276specific to the language, framework or application in use.
277
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100279assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200297as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
298normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
299representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
300HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301
302The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
303that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
304is one valid form of empty line.
305
306Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
307headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
308about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
309application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
310
311Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000312 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
314 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
315 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
316
317
3181.3. HTTP response
319------------------
320
321An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
322messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
323
324 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100325 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
327 2 Content-length: 350
328 3 Content-Type: text/html
329
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
331codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
332response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100333continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
334the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
335following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
336sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
337(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
338correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
339such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
340state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400341over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100342if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
343information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003461.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347------------------------
348
349Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
350
351 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
352 - a status code : 200
353 - a reason : OK
354
355The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100356 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
357 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
358 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
359 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
360 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000362Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100363"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
365messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
366or "Authentication Required".
367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100368HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369
370 Code When / reason
371 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
372 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100375 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
376 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 400 for an invalid or too large request
378 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
379 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100381 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100383 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
384 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400387 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100388 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200390 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200391 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
392 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
393 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
394
395The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3964.2).
397
398
3991.3.2. The response headers
400---------------------------
401
402Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
403the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
404details.
405
406
4072. Configuring HAProxy
408----------------------
409
4102.1. Configuration file format
411------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200412
413HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
414
415 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700417 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200419
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100420The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
421a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100422
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100423 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
424
425 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
426
427 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
428 tab characters
429
430 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
431 keyword sequences listed in this document
432
433 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
434 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
435 parts of the configuration, or expressions
436
437 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
438 are supported
439
440 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
441 section
442
443This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
444generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
445figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
446
447First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
448the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
449a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
450word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
451follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
452the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
453the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
454the parts that need to be addressed.
455
456A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
457requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
458extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
459the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
460section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
461section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
462not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
463
464A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
465each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
466a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
467start a new one.
468
469Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
470that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
471applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
472"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
473processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
474ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
475which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
476In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
477of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
478identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
479such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4802, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
481
482 listen foo
483 bind :80
484
485 listen bar
486 bind :81
487
488Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
489spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
490of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
491following configurations are strictly equivalent:
492
493 global#this is the global section
494 daemon#daemonize
495 frontend foo
496 mode http # or tcp
497
498and:
499
500 global
501 daemon
502
503 # this is the public web frontend
504 frontend foo
505 mode http
506
507The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
508new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
509other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
510section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
511section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
512at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
513
514Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
515are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
516editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
517support automatic indent.
518
519In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
520positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
521modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
522anymore, and is not recommended.
523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200524
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005252.2. Quoting and escaping
526-------------------------
527
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100528In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
529that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
530possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
531in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
532('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
535very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
536the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
537also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
538delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
539word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
540remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200541
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100542If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
543(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
544
545Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
546backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
548 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
549 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
550 \\ to use a backslash
551 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
552 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
553
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100554In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
555C-language representation:
556
557 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
558 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
559 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
560 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
561
562Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
563or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
564of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200567 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
568 # hash as a comment start
569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
571evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
572dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
573backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200574
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100575Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
576character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
577is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200578
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100579As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
580entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
581name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
582represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
583hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
586 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
587 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
588 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
589 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
590 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
591 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
592 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
593 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
594 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
595 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200596
597 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100598 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200599 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
601 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
603 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
604
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100605There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
606necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
607by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
608they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
609escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
610characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
611case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
612if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
613own quotes.
614
615The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
616quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500617not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100618quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
619
620Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
621arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
622
623 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
624 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
625
626Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
627"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
628cannot write:
629
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
631
632because we would like the string to cut like this:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |---------|----|-|
636 arg1 _/ / /
637 arg2 __________/ /
638 arg3 ______________/
639
640but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
641parenthesis then garbage:
642
643 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
644 |--------|--------|
645 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
646 trailing garbage _________/
647
648The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
649quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
650processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
651this word:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
656
657So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
658still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
659the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
660the second level:
661
662 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
663 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
664 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
665 |---------||----|-|
666 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
667 arg2=blah ___________/ /
668 arg3=g _______________/
669
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500670Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100671double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
672
673 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
674 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
675 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
676 |---------||----|-|
677 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
678 arg2 ___________/ /
679 arg3 _______________/
680
681When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
682appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
683string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
684thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
685
686 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
687 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
688 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
689 |-------------| |-----||-|
690 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
691 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
692 arg3 ______________________/
693
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400694Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
696quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
697single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
698level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
699
700When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
701double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
702and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
703a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
704a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
705the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
706regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
707around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
708more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200709
710
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007112.3. Environment variables
712--------------------------
713
714HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
715interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
716configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
717optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
718shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200719underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
720list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
721arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
722before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200723
724 Example:
725
726 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
727
728 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
729
730 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
731
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200732Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
733file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200734
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200735* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
736 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
737
738* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
739 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
740 directory.
741
742* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
743
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500744* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200745 processes, separated by semicolons.
746
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500747* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200748 CLI, separated by semicolons.
749
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200750In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
751regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
752only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
753
754* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
755
756* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
757 starting at one.
758
759* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
760 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
761 first section.
762
763These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
764if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
765section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
766"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
767proxies.
768
769This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
770logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
771to name some config objects like servers for example.
772
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200773See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200774
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100775
7762.4. Conditional blocks
777-----------------------
778
779It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
780some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
781ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
782configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
783versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
784preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
785text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
786lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
787switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
788are defined to form conditional blocks:
789
790 - .if <condition>
791 - .elif <condition>
792 - .else
793 - .endif
794
795The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
796as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
797matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
798there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
799only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
800".elif" of a block.
801
802Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
803ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
804as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
805
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200806Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
807See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
808
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200809The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
810expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100811
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100812 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
813 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200814 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200815 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530816 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
817 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200818 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
819 from left to right until one returns false
820 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
821 from right to left until one returns true
822
823Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
824operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200825
826The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
827
828 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
829 exists, regardless of its contents
830
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200831 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
832 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
833 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
834
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200835 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
836 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
837
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200838 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
839 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
840 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
841 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
842
843 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
844 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
845 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
846 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
847
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200848Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100849
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200850 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
851 listen mwcli_px
852 bind :1111
853 ...
854 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100855
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200856 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
857 bind :80
858 .endif
859
860 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200861 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200862 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200863 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200864 .endif
865
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200866 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200867 bind :443 ssl crt ...
868 .endif
869
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200870 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
871 profiling.memory on
872 .endif
873
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200874 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
875 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
876 .endif
877
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200878Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100879
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200880 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100881 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
882 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
883 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
884
885Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
886"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
887fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
888provide advice to the user.
889
890Example:
891
892 .if "${A}"
893 .if "${B}"
894 .notice "A=1, B=1"
895 .elif "${C}"
896 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
897 .elif "${D}"
898 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
899 .else
900 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
901 .endif
902 .else
903 .notice "A=0"
904 .endif
905
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200906 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
907 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
908
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100909
9102.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200911----------------
912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100913Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
915otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
916numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
917for every keyword. Supported units are :
918
919 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
920 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
921 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
922 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
923 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
924 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
925
926
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009272.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200928-------------
929
930 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
931 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
932 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
933 global
934 daemon
935 maxconn 256
936
937 defaults
938 mode http
939 timeout connect 5000ms
940 timeout client 50000ms
941 timeout server 50000ms
942
943 frontend http-in
944 bind *:80
945 default_backend servers
946
947 backend servers
948 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
949
950
951 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
952 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
953 global
954 daemon
955 maxconn 256
956
957 defaults
958 mode http
959 timeout connect 5000ms
960 timeout client 50000ms
961 timeout server 50000ms
962
963 listen http-in
964 bind *:80
965 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
966
967
968Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
969
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100970 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200971
972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009733. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200974--------------------
975
976Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
977are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
978of them have command-line equivalents.
979
980The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
981
982 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200983 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200984 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200985 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200986 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200987 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200988 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200989 - description
990 - deviceatlas-json-file
991 - deviceatlas-log-level
992 - deviceatlas-separator
993 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200994 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900995 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200996 - gid
997 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100998 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200999 - h1-case-adjust
1000 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001001 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001002 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001003 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001004 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001005 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001007 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001008 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001009 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001010 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001011 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001012 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001013 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001014 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001015 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001016 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001017 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001018 - presetenv
1019 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020 - uid
1021 - ulimit-n
1022 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001023 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001024 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001025 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001026 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001027 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001028 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001029 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001030 - ssl-default-bind-options
1031 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001032 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001033 - ssl-default-server-options
1034 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001035 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001036 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001037 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001038 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001039 - 51degrees-data-file
1040 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001041 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001042 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001043 - wurfl-data-file
1044 - wurfl-information-list
1045 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001046 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001047 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001048
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001049 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001050 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001051 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001052 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001053 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001054 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001055 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001056 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001057 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001058 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001059 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001060 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 - noepoll
1062 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001063 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001065 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001066 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001067 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001068 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001069 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001070 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001071 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001072 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001073 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001074 - tune.buffers.limit
1075 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001076 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001077 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001078 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001079 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001080 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001081 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001082 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001083 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001084 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001085 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001086 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001087 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001088 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001089 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1090 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001091 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001092 - tune.maxaccept
1093 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001094 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001095 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001096 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001097 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1098 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001099 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1100 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001101 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001102 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001103 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001104 - tune.sndbuf.client
1105 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001106 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001107 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001108 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001109 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001110 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001111 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001112 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02001113 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1114 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001115 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001116 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001117 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1118 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1119 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001120 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1121 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001122
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001123 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001125 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001126
1127
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011283.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001129------------------------------------
1130
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001131ca-base <dir>
1132 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001133 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1134 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1135 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001136
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001137chroot <jail dir>
1138 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1139 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1140 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1141 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1142 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001143 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001144
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001145cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001146 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001147 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1148 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1149 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1150 set. These sets have the format
1151
1152 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1153
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001154 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1155 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001156 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001157 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001158 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1159 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001160 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1161 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1162 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1163 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1164 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1165 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1166 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1167 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1168 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1169 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001170
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001171 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1172 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1173 on the machine's word size.
1174
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001175 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001176 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1177 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1178 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1179 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1180 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1181 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001182
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001183 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1184 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1185 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1186 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001187
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001188 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001189 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1190 # first 4 CPUs
1191
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001192 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1193 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001194 # word size.
1195
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001196 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1197 # and so on.
1198 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1199 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1200 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1201
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001202 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1203 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1204 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1205 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001206
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001207 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1208 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1209 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001210
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001211crt-base <dir>
1212 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001213 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1214 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001215
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001216daemon
1217 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1218 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001219 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1220 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001221
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001222default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001223 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001224 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1225 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1226 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1227 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1228 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1229 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1230 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1231 not start with a slash ('/'):
1232 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1233 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1234
1235 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1236 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1237 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1238 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1239 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1240 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1241 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1242 each of them.
1243
1244 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1245 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1246 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1247 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1248 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1249 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1250 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1251 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1252
1253 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1254 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001255 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001256 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1257 made easily relocatable.
1258
1259 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1260 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1261 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1262 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1263 consistent across all configuration files.
1264
1265 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1266 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1267 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1268 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1269 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1270 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1271 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1272 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1273
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001274deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1275 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001276 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001277
1278deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001279 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001280 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1281
1282deviceatlas-separator <char>
1283 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1284 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1285
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001286deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001287 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1288 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1289 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001290
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001291expose-experimental-directives
1292 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1293 the config file will be rejected.
1294
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001295external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001296 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1297 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001298 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1299 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1300 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1301 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1302 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001303
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001304gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001305 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001306 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1307 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001308 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001309 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001310 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001311
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001312group <group name>
1313 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1314 See also "gid" and "user".
1315
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001316hard-stop-after <time>
1317 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1318
1319 Arguments :
1320 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1321 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1322 SIGUSR1 signal.
1323
1324 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1325 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1326 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1327
1328 Example:
1329 global
1330 hard-stop-after 30s
1331
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001332h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1333 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1334 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1335 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1336 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001337 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001338 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1339 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1340 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1341 specified in a proxy.
1342
1343 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1344 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1345 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1346 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1347 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1348 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1349 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1350
1351 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1352 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1353 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1354 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1355 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1356
1357 Example:
1358 global
1359 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1360
1361 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1362 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1363
1364h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1365 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1366 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1367 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1368 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1369 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1370 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1371 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1372 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1373
1374 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1375 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1376 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1377
1378 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1379 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1380
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001381insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001382 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001383 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1384 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1385 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1386 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1387 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1388 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1389 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001390 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001391 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1392 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1393 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1394 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1395 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1396 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1397 disable it.
1398
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001399insecure-setuid-wanted
1400 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1401 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1402 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1403 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001404 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001405 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001406 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001407 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1408 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001409 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001410 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1411 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1412 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1413 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1414
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001415issuers-chain-path <dir>
1416 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1417 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1418 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001419 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001420 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1421 "issuers-chain-path".
1422 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1423 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1424 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1425 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1426 will share the chain in memory.
1427
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001428h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1429 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1430 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1431 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1432 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1433 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1434 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1435 the keyword with "no'.
1436
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001437localpeer <name>
1438 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1439 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1440 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1441 the configuration parsing.
1442
1443 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1444 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1445
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001446log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001447 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001448 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001449 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001450 configured with "log global".
1451
1452 <address> can be one of:
1453
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001454 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001455 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1456 port).
1457
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001458 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1459 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1460 port).
1461
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001462 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001463 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1464 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001465 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001466
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001467 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1468 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1469 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1470 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1471 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1472 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1473 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1474 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1475 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1476 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001477 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001478 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1479 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1480 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001481 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1482 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001483
1484 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1485 "fd@2", see above.
1486
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001487 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1488 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1489 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1490 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1491 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1492
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001493 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1494 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001495
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001496 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1497 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1498 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1499 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1500 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1501 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1502 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1503 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1504 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1505 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001506 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1507 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001508
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001509 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1510 one of the following :
1511
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001512 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1513 field is stripped. This is the default.
1514 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1515 rfc3164.
1516
1517 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001518 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1519
1520 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1521 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1522
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001523 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1524 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1525 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1526 designed to be used with a local log server.
1527
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001528 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1529 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1530 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1531 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1532 logger consumes.
1533
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001534 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1535 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1536 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1537 used with a local log server.
1538
1539 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1540 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1541 designed to be used with a local log server.
1542
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001543 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1544 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1545 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1546 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1547
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001548 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1549 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1550 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1551 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1552 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1553
1554 <sample_size>
1555 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1556 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1557 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1558 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1559 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1560
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001561 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001562
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001563 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1564 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1565 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1566
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001567 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1568 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1569 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1570 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001571
1572 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001573 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1574 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1575 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1576 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1577 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1578 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001579
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001580 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001581
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001582log-send-hostname [<string>]
1583 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1584 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1585 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1586 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1587 the logs.
1588
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001589log-tag <string>
1590 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1591 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1592 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001593 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001594
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001595lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001596 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1597 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1598 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1599 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1600 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1601 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001602 used multiple times.
1603
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001604lua-load-per-thread <file>
1605 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1606 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1607 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1608 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1609 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1610 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1611 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1612 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1613 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1614 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1615 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1616 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1617 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1618 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1619 times.
1620
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001621lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1622 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1623 variable.
1624 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1625 to "path".
1626
1627 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1628 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1629 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1630 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1631 will be checked earlier.
1632
1633 As an example by specifying the following path:
1634
1635 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1636 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1637
1638 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1639 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1640 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1641 paths if that does not exist either.
1642
1643 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1644 documentation.
1645
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001646master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001647 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1648 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1649 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001650 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001651 or daemon mode.
1652
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001653 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1654 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1655 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1656 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1657 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001658
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001659 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001660
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001661mworker-max-reloads <number>
1662 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001663 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001664 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1665 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1666 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1667
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001668nbthread <number>
1669 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001670 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1671 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1672 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1673 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1674 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1675 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1676 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001677
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001678numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001679 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001680 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1681 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1682 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1683 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1684 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1685 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1686 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1687 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001689pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001690 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1691 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1692 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1693 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001694
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001695pp2-never-send-local
1696 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1697 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1698 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1699 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1700 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1701 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1702 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1703 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1704 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1705 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1706 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1707
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001708presetenv <name> <value>
1709 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1710 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1711 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1712 and "unsetenv".
1713
1714resetenv [<name> ...]
1715 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1716 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1717 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1718 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1719 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1720 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1721 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1722 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1723
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001724stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001725 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1726 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1727 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001728
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001729server-state-base <directory>
1730 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001731 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1732 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001733
1734server-state-file <file>
1735 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1736 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1737 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1738 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1739 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1740 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1741 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1742 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001743 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1744 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001745
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001746set-var <var-name> <expr>
1747 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1748 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1749 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1750 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1751 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1752 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1753 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1754 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1755 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1756
1757 Example:
1758 global
1759 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1760 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1761 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1762
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001763setenv <name> <value>
1764 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1765 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1766 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1767 and "unsetenv".
1768
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001769set-dumpable
1770 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001771 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1772 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1773 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1774 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1775 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1776 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1777 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1778 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1779 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1780 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1781 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1782 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1783 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1784 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1785 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001786 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001787 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001788
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001789ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1790 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1791 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001792 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001793 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001794 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1795 information and recommendations see e.g.
1796 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1797 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1798 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1799 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001800
1801ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1802 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1803 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1804 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1805 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1806 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001807 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1808 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1809 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001810 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001811
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001812ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1814 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1815 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1816 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1817 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1818
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001819ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1820 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1821 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1822 keyword to see available options.
1823
1824 Example:
1825 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001826 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001827
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001828ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1829 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1830 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001831 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001832 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001833 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1834 information and recommendations see e.g.
1835 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1836 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1837 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1838 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1839 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001840
1841ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1842 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1843 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1844 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1845 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1846 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001847 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1848 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1849 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1850 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001851
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001852ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1853 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1854 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1855 keyword to see available options.
1856
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001857ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1859 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1860 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001861 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001862 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001863 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1864 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1865 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1866 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001867 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1868 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1869 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1870
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001871ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1872 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1873 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001874 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001875 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001876 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1877
1878 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001879
1880 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1881 and won't try to remove them.
1882
1883 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1884
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001885ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001886 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001887 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1888 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1889 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001890
1891 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1892 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1893 optimize the startup time.
1894
1895 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1896 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1897 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1898
1899 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001900 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001901
1902 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001903 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1904 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001905
1906 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1907 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1908 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1909 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1910 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001911 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001912
1913 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001914 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001915 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1916 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1917 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1918 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1919 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001920 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001921
1922 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1923
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001924 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001925 a cert bundle.
1926
1927 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1928 separately in several "crt".
1929
1930 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1931 since files are loading separately.
1932
1933 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1934 required to commit them.
1935
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001936 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001937 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001938
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001939 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1940 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1941 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001942
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001943 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1944 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1945 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001946
1947 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001948 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
1949 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001950
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001951 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1952 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1953
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001954 The default behavior is "all".
1955
1956 Example:
1957 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1958 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1959 ssl-load-extra-files none
1960
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001961 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
1962 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001963
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001964ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1965 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1966 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1967 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1968
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001969ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001970 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001971 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1972 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1973 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1974 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1975 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1976 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001977 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001978
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001979stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1980 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1981 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1982 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001983 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001984 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001985
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001986 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1987 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1988 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001989
1990stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1991 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1992 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001993 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001994
1995stats maxconn <connections>
1996 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1997 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1998
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001999uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002000 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002001 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2002 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2003 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2004
2005ulimit-n <number>
2006 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2007 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2008 option.
2009
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002010 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2011 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2012 manually specify this value.
2013
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002014unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2015 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2016
2017 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2018 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2019 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2020 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2021 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002022 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002023 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2024 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2025 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2026 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2027
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002028unsetenv [<name> ...]
2029 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2030 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2031 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2032 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2033 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2034 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2035 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2036
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002037user <user name>
2038 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2039 See also "uid" and "group".
2040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002041node <name>
2042 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2043
2044 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2045 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2046 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2047 traffic.
2048
2049description <text>
2050 Add a text that describes the instance.
2051
2052 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2053 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2054 "<" and ">" characters.
2055
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100205651degrees-data-file <file path>
2057 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002058 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002059
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002060 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002061 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2062
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000206351degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002064 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2065 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2066 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2067
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002068 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002069 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2070
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200207151degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002072 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2073 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2074
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002075 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002076 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2077
207851degrees-cache-size <number>
2079 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2080 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2081 By default, this cache is disabled.
2082
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002083 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002084 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2085
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002086wurfl-data-file <file path>
2087 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2088 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2089
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002090 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002091 with USE_WURFL=1.
2092
2093wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2094 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2095 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2096 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2097
2098 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2099
2100 Valid WURFL properties are:
2101 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2102
2103 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2104 device.
2105
2106 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2107 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2108
2109 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2110 particular web request.
2111
2112 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2113 used Libwurfl API version.
2114
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002115 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2116 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2117
2118 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2119 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2120
2121 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2122
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002123 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002124 with USE_WURFL=1.
2125
2126wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2127 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2128 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2129
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002130 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002131 with USE_WURFL=1.
2132
2133wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2134 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2135 thus before the chroot.
2136
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002137 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002138 with USE_WURFL=1.
2139
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002140wurfl-cache-size <size>
2141 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2142 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002143 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002144 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002145
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002146 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002147 with USE_WURFL=1.
2148
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002149strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002150 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002151 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2152 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002153 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002154 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002155
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021563.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002157-----------------------
2158
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002159busy-polling
2160 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2161 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2162 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2163 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2164 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2165 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2166 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2167 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2168 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2169 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2170 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2171 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2172 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2173 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2174 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2175 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2176 "poll" pollers.
2177
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002178 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2179 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2180 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2181
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002182max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002183 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002184 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2185 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2186 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2187 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2188 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2189 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2190 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2191
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002192maxconn <number>
2193 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2194 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2195 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002196 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2197 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2198 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2199 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002200 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2201 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2202 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2203 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2204 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2205 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002206
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002207maxconnrate <number>
2208 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2209 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2210 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2211 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2212 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2213 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2214 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2215 fairness.
2216
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002217maxcomprate <number>
2218 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002219 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002220 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2221 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2222 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002223 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002224 default value.
2225
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002226maxcompcpuusage <number>
2227 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2228 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2229 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002230 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2231 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2232 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2233 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002234
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002235maxpipes <number>
2236 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2237 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2238 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2239 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2240 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2241 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2242
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002243maxsessrate <number>
2244 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2245 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2246 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2247 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2248 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2249 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2250 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2251 fairness.
2252
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002253maxsslconn <number>
2254 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2255 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2256 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2257 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2258 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2259 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2260 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002261 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2262 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2263 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2264 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002265 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002266 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2267 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002268
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002269maxsslrate <number>
2270 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2271 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2272 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2273 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2274 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2275 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2276 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2277 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2278 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2279 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2280
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002281maxzlibmem <number>
2282 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2283 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2284 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002285 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2286 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2287 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2288
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002289noepoll
2290 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2291 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002292 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002293
2294nokqueue
2295 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2296 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2297 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2298
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002299noevports
2300 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2301 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2302 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2303 also "nopoll".
2304
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002305nopoll
2306 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2307 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002308 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002309 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2310 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002311
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002312nosplice
2313 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002314 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002315 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002316 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002317 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2318 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2319 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2320 "option splice-response".
2321
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002322nogetaddrinfo
2323 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2324 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2325
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002326noreuseport
2327 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2328 command line argument "-dR".
2329
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002330profiling.memory { on | off }
2331 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2332 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2333 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2334 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2335 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2336 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2337 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2338 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2339 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2340
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002341profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2342 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2343 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2344 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2345 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002346 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002347 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2348 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2349 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2350 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2351
2352 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2353 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2354 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2355 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2356 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002357 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2358 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2359 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2360 CLI.
2361
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002362spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002363 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2364 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2365 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2366 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2367 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2368 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002369
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002370ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002371 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002372 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002373 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002374 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002375 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2376 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2377 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002378 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2379 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002380 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2381 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2382 openssl configuration file uses:
2383 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2384
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002385ssl-mode-async
2386 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002387 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002388 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2389 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002390 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002391 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002392 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002393
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002394tune.buffers.limit <number>
2395 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2396 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2397 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2398 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2399 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002400 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002401 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2402 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2403 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2404 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2405 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2406 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2407 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2408 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002409 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002410
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002411tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2412 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2413 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2414 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002415 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002416
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002417tune.bufsize <number>
2418 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2419 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2420 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2421 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2422 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2423 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2424 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002425 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2426 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002427 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002428 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002429 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002430 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2431 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002432
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002433tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2434 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2435 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2436 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2437 this value. The default value is 1.
2438
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002439tune.fail-alloc
2440 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2441 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2442 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2443 gracefully.
2444
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002445tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2446 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2447 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2448 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2449 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2450 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2451
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002452tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2453 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2454 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2455 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2456 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2457 change it.
2458
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002459tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2460 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002461 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002462 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002463 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2464 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2465 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2466 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2467 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2468
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002469tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2470 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2471 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2472 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2473 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2474 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002475 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002476 recommended not to change this value.
2477
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002478tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002479 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002480 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002481 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002482 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2483 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2484 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2485 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2486
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002487tune.http.cookielen <number>
2488 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2489 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2490 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2491 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2492 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2493 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2494 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2495 to change this value.
2496
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002497tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002498 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2499 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002500 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002501 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002502 configuration directives too.
2503 The default value is 1024.
2504
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002505tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2506 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2507 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2508 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2509 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2510 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2511 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002512 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2513 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2514 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002515
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002516tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2517 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2518 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2519 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2520 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2521 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2522 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002523 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2524 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2525 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2526 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2527 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002528
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002529tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002530 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002531 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2532 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2533 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2534 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002535 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002536 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002537 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002538 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2539
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002540tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2541 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2542 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2543 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2544 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2545 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2546 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2547 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2548 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2549 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2550
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002551tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2552 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002553 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002554 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2555 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002556 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002557 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2558 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2559
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002560tune.lua.maxmem
2561 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2562 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2563 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2564 memory.
2565
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002566tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2567 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002568 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2569 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002570 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002571
2572tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2573 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2574 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2575 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2576 check servers.
2577
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002578tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2579 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2580 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2581 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002582 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002583
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002584tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002585 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2586 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002587 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2588 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2589 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2590 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2591 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2592 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2593 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2594 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2595 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002596
2597tune.maxpollevents <number>
2598 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2599 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2600 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2601 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2602 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2603
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002604tune.maxrewrite <number>
2605 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2606 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2607 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2608 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2609 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2610 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2611 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2612 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2613 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2614 bufsize.
2615
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002616tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2617 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2618 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2619 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2620 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2621 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2622 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2623 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2624 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2625 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002626 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2627 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002628 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2629 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2630 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2631 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2632 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2633 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2634 setting this parameter to 0.
2635
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002636tune.pipesize <number>
2637 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2638 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2639 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2640 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2641 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2642 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2643
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002644tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2645 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002646 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002647 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2648 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2649 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2650 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002651 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002652
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002653tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2654 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002655 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002656 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2657 default is 20.
2658
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002659tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2660tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2661 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2662 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2663 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002664 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002665 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002666 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2667 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2668
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002669tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002670 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002671 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2672 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2673 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2674 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2675
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002676tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002677 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002678 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2679 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2680 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2681 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2682 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2683 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2684 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002685
2686tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2687 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002688 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002689 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2690 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2691 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2692 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2693 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2694 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2695 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002696
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002697tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2698tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2699 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2700 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2701 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002702 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002703 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002704 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2705 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2706 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2707 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002708 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002709
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002710tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002711 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002712 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2713 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2714 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2715 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2716 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2717 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2718 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2719 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2720 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002721 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
2722 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002723
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002724tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002725 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002726 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2727 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2728 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2729 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2730 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2731
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002732tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2733 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2734 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2735 performances. This is disabled by default.
2736
2737 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2738 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2739
2740 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2741
2742 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2743
2744 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2745
2746 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2747 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2748 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2749
2750 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2751 converted.
2752
2753 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2754 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2755 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2756 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2757 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2758 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2759 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002760 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2761 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002762
2763 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2764
2765 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2766 only need this line:
2767
2768 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2769
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002770tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2771 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002772 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002773 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2774 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2775 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2776 being used for too long.
2777
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002778tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2779 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2780 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2781 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2782 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2783 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2784 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2785 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2786 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2787 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2788 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002789 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002790 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002791
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002792tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2793 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2794 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2795 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2796 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002797 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002798 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2799 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002800 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2801 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002802
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002803tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2804 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2805 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2806 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2807 1000 entries.
2808
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02002809tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
2810tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
Marcin Deranek769fd2e2021-07-12 14:16:55 +02002811 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2812 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2813 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2814 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002815
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002816tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002817tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002818tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2819tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2820tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002821 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2822 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2823 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2824 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2825 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2826 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2827 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2828 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002829
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002830 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2831 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2832 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2833 all available space is consumed.
2834 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2835 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2836 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002837
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002838tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2839 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002840 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002841 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002842 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002843 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2844
2845tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2846 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2847 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002848 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2849 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002850
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028513.3. Debugging
2852--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002853
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002854quiet
2855 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2856 line argument "-q".
2857
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002858zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002859 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002860 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2861 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2862 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2863 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2864 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2865
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002866
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028673.4. Userlists
2868--------------
2869It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2870http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2871it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2872
2873userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002874 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002875 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2876
2877group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002878 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002879 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2880 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2881
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002882user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2883 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002884 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2885 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002886 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2887 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2888 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2889 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002890
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002891 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2892 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2893 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2894 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2895 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2896 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2897 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002898 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002899 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002900
2901 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002902 userlist L1
2903 group G1 users tiger,scott
2904 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002905
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002906 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2907 user scott insecure-password elgato
2908 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002909
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002910 userlist L2
2911 group G1
2912 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002913
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002914 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2915 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2916 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002917
2918 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002919
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002920
29213.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002922----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002923It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002924several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002925instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2926values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2927automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2928In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2929using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2930tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2931reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2932Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2933that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2934each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002935
2936peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002937 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002938 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2939
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002940bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2941 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2942 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2943
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002944disabled
2945 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2946 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2947 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2948
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002949default-bind [param*]
2950 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2951
2952default-server [param*]
2953 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2954
2955 Arguments:
2956 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2957 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2958 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2959 details.
2960
2961
2962 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2963
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002964enable
2965 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2966
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002967log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002968 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2969 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2970 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2971 more details.
2972
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002973peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002974 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2975 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002976 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002977 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002978 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2979 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2980 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002981
2982 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2983 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2984
2985 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002986 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2987 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2988 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002989
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002990 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2991 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002992
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002993 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2994 "server" keyword explanation below).
2995
2996server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002997 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002998 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2999 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
3000 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
3001 of this "peers" section).
3002 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3003
3004
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003005 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003006 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003007 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003008 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3009 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3010 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003011
3012 backend mybackend
3013 mode tcp
3014 balance roundrobin
3015 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3016 stick on src
3017
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003018 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3019 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003020
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003021 Example:
3022 peers mypeers
3023 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3024 default-server ssl verify none
3025 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3026 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003027
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003028
3029table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3030 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3031
3032 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3033 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003034 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003035 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3036 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3037 "stick-table" keyword).
3038
3039 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3040 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3041 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3042 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3043 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3044 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3045 of the stick-table name as follows:
3046
3047 peers mypeers
3048 peer A ...
3049 peer B ...
3050 table t1 ...
3051
3052 frontend fe1
3053 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3054
3055 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3056 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3057
3058 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3059 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3060 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3061 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3062 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3063 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3064 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3065
3066 peers mypeers
3067 peer A ...
3068 peer B ...
3069 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3070
3071 backend t1
3072 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3073
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003074 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003075 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3076 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3077
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030783.6. Mailers
3079------------
3080It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3081If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3082in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3083
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003084mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003085 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3086 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3087
3088mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3089 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3090
3091 Example:
3092 mailers mymailers
3093 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3094 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3095
3096 backend mybackend
3097 mode tcp
3098 balance roundrobin
3099
3100 email-alert mailers mymailers
3101 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3102 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3103
3104 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3105 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3106
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003107timeout mail <time>
3108 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3109 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3110 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3111 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3112
3113 Example:
3114 mailers mymailers
3115 timeout mail 20s
3116 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003117
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031183.7. Programs
3119-------------
3120In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3121master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3122managed the same way as the workers.
3123
3124During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3125sequence as a worker:
3126
3127 - the master is re-executed
3128 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3129 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3130 instance of the program
3131
3132During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3133
3134program <name>
3135 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3136 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3137 the management guide).
3138
3139command <command> [arguments*]
3140 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3141 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3142 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3143 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3144
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003145user <user name>
3146 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3147 See also "group".
3148
3149group <group name>
3150 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3151 See also "user".
3152
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003153option start-on-reload
3154no option start-on-reload
3155 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3156 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3157 program section.
3158
3159
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031603.8. HTTP-errors
3161----------------
3162
3163It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3164imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3165several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3166
3167http-errors <name>
3168 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3169 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3170
3171errorfile <code> <file>
3172 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3173
3174 Arguments :
3175 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003176 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003177 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003178
3179 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3180 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3181 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3182 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3183 before any chroot is performed.
3184
3185 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3186
3187 Example:
3188 http-errors website-1
3189 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3190 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3191 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3192
3193 http-errors website-2
3194 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3195 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3196 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3197
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020031983.9. Rings
3199----------
3200
3201It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3202servers or traces.
3203
3204ring <ringname>
3205 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3206
3207description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003208 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003209 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3210
3211format <format>
3212 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3213
3214 Arguments:
3215 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3216 one of the following :
3217
3218 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3219 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3220 designed to be used with a local log server.
3221
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003222 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3223 field is stripped. This is the default.
3224 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3225 rfc3164.
3226
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003227 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3228 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3229 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3230 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3231 is the default.
3232
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003233 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003234 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3235
3236 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3237 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3238
3239 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3240 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3241 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3242 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3243 logger consumes.
3244
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003245 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3246 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3247 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3248 with a local log server.
3249
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003250 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3251 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3252 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3253 used with a local log server.
3254
3255maxlen <length>
3256 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3257 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3258 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3259
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003260server <name> <address> [param*]
3261 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3262 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3263 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3264 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3265 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3266 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3267 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3268 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3269 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003270 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3271 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003272
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003273size <size>
3274 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3275 set to BUFSIZE.
3276
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003277timeout connect <timeout>
3278 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3279
3280 Arguments :
3281 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3282 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3283 as explained at the top of this document.
3284
3285timeout server <timeout>
3286 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3287
3288 Arguments :
3289 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3290 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3291 as explained at the top of this document.
3292
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003293 Example:
3294 global
3295 log ring@myring local7
3296
3297 ring myring
3298 description "My local buffer"
3299 format rfc3164
3300 maxlen 1200
3301 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003302 timeout connect 5s
3303 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003304 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003305
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033063.10. Log forwarding
3307-------------------
3308
3309It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003310HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003311
3312log-forward <name>
3313 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3314
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003315backlog <conns>
3316 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3317 on connections accept.
3318
3319bind <addr> [param*]
3320 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003321 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3322 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3323 syslog protocol over TCP.
3324 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003325 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3326
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003327dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003328 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3329 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3330 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3331 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003332 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003333
3334log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003335log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003336 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3337 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3338 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003339 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003340 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3341 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3342 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003343 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003344
3345 Example:
3346 global
3347 log stderr format iso local7
3348
3349 ring myring
3350 description "My local buffer"
3351 format rfc5424
3352 maxlen 1200
3353 size 32764
3354 timeout connect 5s
3355 timeout server 10s
3356 # syslog tcp server
3357 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3358
3359 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003360 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3361 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003362 # all messages on stderr
3363 log global
3364 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3365 log ring@myring local0
3366 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3367 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3368 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3369 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3370 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003371
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003372maxconn <conns>
3373 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3374 10 is the default.
3375
3376timeout client <timeout>
3377 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033794. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003380----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003381
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003382Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003383 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3384 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3385 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3386 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003387
3388A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3389connections.
3390
3391A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3392to forward incoming connections.
3393
3394A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3395parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3396
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003397A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3398ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3399sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3400the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3401explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3402from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3403"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3404for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3405to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3406optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3407are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3408any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3409names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3410that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3411duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3412names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3413
3414Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3415settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3416of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3417profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3418timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3419
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3421'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3422case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3423
3424Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3425logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3426proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3427However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3428name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3429
3430Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3431and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003432bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003433protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3434modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3435arbitrary criteria.
3436
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003437In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3438a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003439the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003440
3441 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3442 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3443 between responses and new requests.
3444
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003445 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3446 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3447 client-facing connection remains open.
3448
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003449 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3450 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003451
3452The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3453frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3454following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003455weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003456
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003457 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003458
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003459 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3460 ----+-----+-----+----
3461 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3462 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003463 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3464 ----+-----+-----+----
3465 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003466
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003467It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003468only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3469within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003470as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003471content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003472and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3473possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003474
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003475There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003476first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003477processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003478second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003479protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3480is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3481new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003482to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003483process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3484already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3485HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3486evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3487one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3488
3489There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3490performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3491tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3492preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3493analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3494HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3495header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3496mitigate this drawback.
3497
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003498There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003499method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3500set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3501in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3502is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3503to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3504above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3505to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3506"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3507frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3508frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3509as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3510upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3511on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3512the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3513upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3514frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3515remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035174.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3518--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003520The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3521limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3522they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3523limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003524marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003525option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003526and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3527with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3528specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003529
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003530
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003531 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3532------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3533acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003534backlog X X X -
3535balance X - X X
3536bind - X X -
3537bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003538capture cookie - X X -
3539capture request header - X X -
3540capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003541clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3542clitcpka-idle X X X -
3543clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003544compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003545cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003546declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003547default-server X - X X
3548default_backend X X X -
3549description - X X X
3550disabled X X X X
3551dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003552email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003553email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003554email-alert mailers X X X X
3555email-alert myhostname X X X X
3556email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003557enabled X X X X
3558errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003559errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003560errorloc X X X X
3561errorloc302 X X X X
3562-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3563errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02003564error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003565force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003566filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003567fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003568hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003569http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003570http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003571http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003572http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003573http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003574http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003575http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003576http-check set-var X - X X
3577http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003578http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003579http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003580http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003581http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003582http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003583id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003584ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003585load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003586log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003587log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003588log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003589log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003590max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003591maxconn X X X -
3592mode X X X X
3593monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003594monitor-uri X X X -
3595option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3596option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3597option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3598option allbackups (*) X - X X
3599option checkcache (*) X - X X
3600option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3601option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003602option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003603option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3604option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3606option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003607option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3608option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003609option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003610option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003611option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003612option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003613option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003614option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3615option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3616option httpchk X - X X
3617option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003618option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02003619option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003620option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003621option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003622option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003623option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3624option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3625option logasap (*) X X X -
3626option mysql-check X - X X
3627option nolinger (*) X X X X
3628option originalto X X X X
3629option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003630option pgsql-check X - X X
3631option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003632option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003633option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003634option smtpchk X - X X
3635option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3636option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3637option splice-request (*) X X X X
3638option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003639option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003640option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3641option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3642-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003643option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003644option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3645option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3646option tcpka X X X X
3647option tcplog X X X X
3648option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003649external-check command X - X X
3650external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003651persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3652rate-limit sessions X X X -
3653redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003654-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003655retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003656retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003657server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003658server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003659server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003660source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003661srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3662srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3663srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003664stats admin - X X X
3665stats auth X X X X
3666stats enable X X X X
3667stats hide-version X X X X
3668stats http-request - X X X
3669stats realm X X X X
3670stats refresh X X X X
3671stats scope X X X X
3672stats show-desc X X X X
3673stats show-legends X X X X
3674stats show-node X X X X
3675stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003676-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3677stick match - - X X
3678stick on - - X X
3679stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003680stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003681stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003682tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003683tcp-check connect X - X X
3684tcp-check expect X - X X
3685tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003686tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003687tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003688tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003689tcp-check set-var X - X X
3690tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003691tcp-request connection - X X -
3692tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003693tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003694tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003695tcp-response content - - X X
3696tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003697timeout check X - X X
3698timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003699timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003700timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003701timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3702timeout http-request X X X X
3703timeout queue X - X X
3704timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003705timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003706timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003707timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003708transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003709unique-id-format X X X -
3710unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003711use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003712use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003713use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003714------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3715 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003716
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037184.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3719---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003720
3721This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3722
3723
3724acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3725 Declare or complete an access list.
3726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3727 no | yes | yes | yes
3728 Example:
3729 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3730 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3731 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3732
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003733 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003734
3735
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003736backlog <conns>
3737 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3739 yes | yes | yes | no
3740 Arguments :
3741 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3742 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003743 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003744
3745 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3746 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3747 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3748 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3749 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3750 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3751 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3752 backlog parameter.
3753
3754 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3755 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3756 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3757
3758 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3759
3760
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003761balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003762balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003763 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3765 yes | no | yes | yes
3766 Arguments :
3767 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3768 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3769 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3770 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3771
3772 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3773 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3774 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3775 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003776 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003777 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003778 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3779 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3780 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3781 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3782 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3783 it, so that you don't worry.
3784
3785 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3786 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3787 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3788 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3789 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3790 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3791 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3792 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003793
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003794 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3795 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3796 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3797 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3798 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3799 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3800 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003801 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3802 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3803 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003804
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003805 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003806 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003807 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3808 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003809 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003810 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3811 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3812 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3813 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3814 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003815 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3816 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3817 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3818 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3819 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3820 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003821
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003822 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3823 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3824 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3825 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3826 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3827 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3828 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3829 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003830 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003831 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003832 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3833 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3834 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003835
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003836 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3837 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3838 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3839 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3840 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3841 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3842 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3843 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3844 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3845 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3846 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3847 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003848
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003849 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003850 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3851 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3852 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3853 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3854 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3855 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3856 URIs start with a leading "/".
3857
3858 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3859 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3860 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3861 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3862
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003863 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3864 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3865 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3866 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3867
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003868 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003869 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3870
3871 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003872 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3873 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003874 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3875 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3876 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3877 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003878 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003879 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3880 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003881
3882 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3883 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3884 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3885 server will receive the request.
3886
3887 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3888 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3889 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3890 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3891 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003892 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3893 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3894 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003895
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003896 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3897 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3898 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3899 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3900 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003902 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003903 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3904 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3905 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3906
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003907 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3908 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3909 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3910
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003911 random
3912 random(<draws>)
3913 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003914 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3915 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3916 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3917 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003918 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3919 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3920 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3921 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3922 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3923 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3924 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3925 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3926 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3927 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3928 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3929 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3930 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3931 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3932 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3933 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3934 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3935 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3936 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3937 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003938
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003939 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003940 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003941 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3942 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3943 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3944 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3945 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3946 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003947 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003948 used instead.
3949
3950 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3951 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3952 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3953 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3954
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003955 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3956 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3957 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3958
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003959 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003960
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003961 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003962 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3963 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003964
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003965 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3966 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3967 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003968
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003969 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003970 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003971 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3972 NTLM relies on.
3973
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003974 Examples :
3975 balance roundrobin
3976 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003977 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003978 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3979 balance hdr(host)
3980 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003981
3982 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3983 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3984
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003985 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003986 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3987 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3988 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003989 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003990
3991 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3992 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3993 defaults to 16 kB.
3994
3995 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3996 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3997
3998 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3999 Round Robin.
4000
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004001 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004002 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4003 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4004 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4005
4006 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4007
4008 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004009 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004010 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4011 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4012 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004013
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004014 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004015
4016
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004017bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4018bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004019 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4021 no | yes | yes | no
4022 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004023 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4024 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4025 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4026 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004027 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004028 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4029 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4030 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4031 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4032 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4033 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004034 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004035 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4036 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004037 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004038 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4039 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004040 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004041 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4042 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004043 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004044 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004045 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4046 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4047 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004048 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4049 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4050 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4051 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004052 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4053 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4054 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004055
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004056 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4057 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004058 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4059 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4060 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004061 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4062 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4063 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4064 the range.
4065
4066 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4067 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4068 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4069 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4070 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4071 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4072 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004073 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004074 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004075
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004076 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004077 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004078 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4079 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4080 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4081 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4082 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4083 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4084
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004085 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4086 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4087 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4088 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4091 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4092 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4093 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4094 in a frontend.
4095
4096 Example :
4097 listen http_proxy
4098 bind :80,:443
4099 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004100 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004101
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004102 listen http_https_proxy
4103 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004104 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004105
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004106 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4107 bind ipv6@:80
4108 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4109 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4110
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004111 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004112 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004113
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004114 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4115 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4116 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4117 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4118 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4119
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004120 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004121 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004122
4123
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004124bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4126 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004127
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004128 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4129 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4130 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4131 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4132 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4133 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004134
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004135 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004136
4137
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004138capture cookie <name> len <length>
4139 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4141 no | yes | yes | no
4142 Arguments :
4143 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4144 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4145 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4146 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004147 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004148
4149 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4150 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4151 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4152 right if it exceeds <length>.
4153
4154 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4155 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4156 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4157 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4158
4159 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4160 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4161 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4162
4163 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4164 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4165 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004166 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4167 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4168 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004169
4170 Example:
4171 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4172
4173 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004174 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004175
4176
4177capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004178 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4180 no | yes | yes | no
4181 Arguments :
4182 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004183 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004184 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4185 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4186 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4187
4188 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4189 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4190 it exceeds <length>.
4191
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004192 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004193 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4194 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004195 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4196 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4197 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4198 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004199 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004200 environments to find where the request came from.
4201
4202 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4203 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4204 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4205 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004206
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004207 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4208 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4209 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4210 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4211 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004212
4213 Example:
4214 capture request header Host len 15
4215 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004216 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004218 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004219 about logging.
4220
4221
4222capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004223 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4225 no | yes | yes | no
4226 Arguments :
4227 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004228 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004229 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4230 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4231 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4232
4233 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4234 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4235 it exceeds <length>.
4236
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004237 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004238 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4239 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4240 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004241 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4242 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4243 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4244 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004245
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004246 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4247 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4248 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4249 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4250 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004251
4252 Example:
4253 capture response header Content-length len 9
4254 capture response header Location len 15
4255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004256 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004257 about logging.
4258
4259
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004260clitcpka-cnt <count>
4261 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4262 the connection on the client side.
4263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4264 yes | yes | yes | no
4265 Arguments :
4266 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4267
4268 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4269 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004270 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4271 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004272
4273 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4274
4275
4276clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4277 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4278 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4279 client side.
4280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4281 yes | yes | yes | no
4282 Arguments :
4283 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4284 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4285 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4286 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4287
4288 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4289 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004290 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4291 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004292
4293 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4294
4295
4296clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4297 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4299 yes | yes | yes | no
4300 Arguments :
4301 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4302 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4303 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4304 document.
4305
4306 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4307 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004308 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4309 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004310
4311 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4312
4313
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004314compression algo <algorithm> ...
4315compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004316compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004317 Enable HTTP compression.
4318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4319 yes | yes | yes | yes
4320 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004321 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4322 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004323 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004324
4325 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004326 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4327 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4328 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004329
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004330 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004331 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004332
4333 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4334 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4335 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4336 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4337 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004338 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004339
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004340 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4341 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4342 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4343 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4344 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4345 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4346 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004347 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004348
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004349 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004350 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004351 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004352 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004353 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004354 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004355 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004356
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004357 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004358 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4359 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004360 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4361 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004362 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004363 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004364 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4365 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004366 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004367 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4368 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004369
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004370 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004371 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4372 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004373 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004374 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004375 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4376 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4377 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4378 "multipart"
4379 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4380 header
4381 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4382 and later
4383 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4384 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004385 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004386
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004387 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004388
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004389 Examples :
4390 compression algo gzip
4391 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004392
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004393
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004394cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004395 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4396 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004397 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004398 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4400 yes | no | yes | yes
4401 Arguments :
4402 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4403 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4404 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4405 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4406 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4407 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004408 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004409 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4410 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4411
4412 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004413 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004414 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4415 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4416 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4417 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004418 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4419 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004420 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004421 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4422 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004423
4424 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004425 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004426
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004427 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004428 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004429 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004430 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004431 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4432 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4433 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4434 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4435 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4436 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4437 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004438
4439 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4440 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4441 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4442 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4443 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4444 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4445 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4446 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4447 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004448 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004449 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4450 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4451 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004452
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004453 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4454 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4455 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004456 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4457 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4458 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4459 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004460 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4461 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4462 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004463
4464 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4465 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4466 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4467 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4468 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4469 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4470 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4471 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4472 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4473
4474 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4475 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4476 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4477 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4478 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4479 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4480 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4481 persistence cookie in the cache.
4482 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4483
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004484 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4485 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004486 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004487 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4488 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004489 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004490 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4491 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4492 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4493 they logout.
4494
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004495 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004496 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4497 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4498 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4499
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004500 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004501 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4502 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4503 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4504 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4505 this attribute.
4506
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004507 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004508 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004509 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4510 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4511 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4512 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4513 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4514 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004515
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004516 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4517 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4518 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4519 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4520 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4521 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4522 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4523 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004524 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004525 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4526 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4527 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4528 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4529 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4530 the site.
4531
4532 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4533 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4534 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4535 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4536 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4537 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4538 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4539 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4540 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4541 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4542 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4543 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4544 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004545 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004546 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4547 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4548
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004549 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4550 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4551 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4552 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4553 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4554 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4555
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004556 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004557 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4558 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4559 repeated.
4560
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004561 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4562 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4563 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4564 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004565
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004566 Examples :
4567 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4568 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4569 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004570 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004571
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004572 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004573
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004574
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004575declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4576 Declares a capture slot.
4577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4578 no | yes | yes | no
4579 Arguments:
4580 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4581
4582 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4583 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4584 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4585 for use in the response.
4586
4587 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004588 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004589 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4590
4591
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004592default-server [param*]
4593 Change default options for a server in a backend
4594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4595 yes | no | yes | yes
4596 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004597 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4598 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4599 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4600 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004601
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004602 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004603 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4604
4605 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004606
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004607
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004608default_backend <backend>
4609 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4611 yes | yes | yes | no
4612 Arguments :
4613 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4614
4615 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4616 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4617 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4618 will catch all undetermined requests.
4619
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004620 Example :
4621
4622 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4623 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4624 default_backend dynamic
4625
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004626 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004628
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004629description <string>
4630 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4632 no | yes | yes | yes
4633 Arguments : string
4634
4635 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4636 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4637 it describes.
4638 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4639
4640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004641disabled
4642 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4644 yes | yes | yes | yes
4645 Arguments : none
4646
4647 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4648 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4649 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4650 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4651 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4652 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4653 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4654
4655 See also : "enabled"
4656
4657
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004658dispatch <address>:<port>
4659 Set a default server address
4660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4661 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004662 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004663
4664 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4665 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4666 during start-up.
4667
4668 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4669 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4670 possible with normal servers.
4671
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004672 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004673 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4674 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4675 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4676 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4677
4678 See also : "server"
4679
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004680
4681dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4682 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4684 yes | no | yes | yes
4685 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4686
4687 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004688 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004689 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4690 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004691 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004692 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004693
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004694enabled
4695 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4697 yes | yes | yes | yes
4698 Arguments : none
4699
4700 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4701 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4702
4703 See also : "disabled"
4704
4705
4706errorfile <code> <file>
4707 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4709 yes | yes | yes | yes
4710 Arguments :
4711 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004712 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004713 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004714
4715 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004716 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004717 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004718 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4719 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004720
4721 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4722 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4723 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4724
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004725 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4726
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004727 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4728 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4729 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4730 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4731 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4732 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4733 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4734 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4735 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004736
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004737 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4738 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4739 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004740 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004741 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4742
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004743 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004744
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004745 Example :
4746 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004747 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004748 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4749 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4750
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004751
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004752errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4753 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4754 section.
4755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4756 yes | yes | yes | yes
4757 Arguments :
4758 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4759
4760 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004761 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004762 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4763 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004764
4765 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4766 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4767 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4768 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4769 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004770 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004771 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4772
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004773 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4774 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004775
4776 Example :
4777 errorfiles generic
4778 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4779
4780
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004781errorloc <code> <url>
4782errorloc302 <code> <url>
4783 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4785 yes | yes | yes | yes
4786 Arguments :
4787 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004788 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004789 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004790
4791 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4792 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4793 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4794 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004795 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004796
4797 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4798 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4799 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4800
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004801 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4802
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004803 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4804 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4805 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4806 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004807 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004808 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4809 request.
4810
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004811 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004812
4813
4814errorloc303 <code> <url>
4815 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4817 yes | yes | yes | yes
4818 Arguments :
4819 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004820 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004821 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004822
4823 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4824 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4825 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4826 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004827 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004828
4829 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4830 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4831 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4832
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004833 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4834
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004835 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4836 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4837 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4838 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004839 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004840
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004841 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004842
4843
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004844email-alert from <emailaddr>
4845 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004846 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004847 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4848 yes | yes | yes | yes
4849
4850 Arguments :
4851
4852 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4853
4854 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4855 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4856
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004857 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004858 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4859 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004860
4861
4862email-alert level <level>
4863 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4864 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4865 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4866 yes | yes | yes | yes
4867
4868 Arguments :
4869
4870 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4871 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4872 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4873
4874 By default level is alert
4875
4876 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4877 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4878 for the proxy.
4879
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004880 Alerts are sent when :
4881
4882 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4883 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4884 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4885 is notice or lower
4886 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4887 and a health check status update occurs
4888
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004889 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4890 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004891 section 3.6 about mailers.
4892
4893
4894email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4895 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4896 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4897 yes | yes | yes | yes
4898
4899 Arguments :
4900
4901 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4902
4903 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4904 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4905
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004906 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4907 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004908
4909
4910email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4911 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4912 mailers.
4913 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4914 yes | yes | yes | yes
4915
4916 Arguments :
4917
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004918 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004919
4920 By default the systems hostname is used.
4921
4922 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4923 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4924 for the proxy.
4925
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004926 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4927 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004928
4929
4930email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004931 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004932 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4934 yes | yes | yes | yes
4935
4936 Arguments :
4937
4938 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4939
4940 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4941 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4942
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004943 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004944 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4945
4946
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02004947error-log-format <string>
4948 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
4949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4950 yes | yes | yes | no
4951
4952 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
4953 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
4954 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
4955 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
4956 connection errors described in section 8.2.6..
4957 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
4958 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4959 string in depth.
4960
4961 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
4962 directives.
4963
4964
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004965force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4966 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4967 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004968 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004969
4970 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4971 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4972 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4973 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4974 marked down for maintenance operations.
4975
4976 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4977 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4978 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4979 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4980 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4981 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4982 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4983 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4984 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4985
4986 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4987 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4988 is used.
4989
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004990 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004991 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004992
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004993
4994filter <name> [param*]
4995 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4997 no | yes | yes | yes
4998 Arguments :
4999 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5000 referenced in section 9.
5001
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005002 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005003 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005004 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5005 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005006
5007 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5008 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5009
5010 Example:
5011 listen
5012 bind *:80
5013
5014 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5015 filter compression
5016 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5017
5018 compression algo gzip
5019 compression offload
5020
5021 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5022
5023 See also : section 9.
5024
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005025
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005026fullconn <conns>
5027 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5029 yes | no | yes | yes
5030 Arguments :
5031 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5032 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5033
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005034 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005035 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005036 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005037 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5038 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5039 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5040 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5041 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005042 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005043
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005044 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005045 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005046 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5047 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5048 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005049
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005050 Example :
5051 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5052 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5053 # connections.
5054 backend dynamic
5055 fullconn 10000
5056 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5057 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5058
5059 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5060
5061
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005062hash-balance-factor <factor>
5063 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5065 yes | no | no | yes
5066 Arguments :
5067 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5068 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005069 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005070
5071 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5072 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5073 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5074 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5075 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5076 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5077 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5078
5079 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5080 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5081 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5082 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5083 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5084
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005085 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5086 consistent hashing mechanism.
5087
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005088 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5089
5090
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005091hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005092 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5094 yes | no | yes | yes
5095 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005096 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5097 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005098
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005099 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5100 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5101 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5102 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5103 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5104 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5105 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5106 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5107 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5108 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005109
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005110 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5111 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5112 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5113 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5114 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5115 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5116 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5117 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5118 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5119 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5120 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5121 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5122 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005123 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5124 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005125
5126 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5127
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005128 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005129 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5130 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5131 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005132 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5133 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5134 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005135
5136 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5137 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005138 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5139 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5140 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5141 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5142
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005143 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005144 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5145 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5146 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5147 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5148 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5149 parameter.
5150
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005151 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5152 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5153 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5154 used on strings.
5155
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005156 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5157
5158 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5159 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5160 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5161 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5162 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5163 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5164 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5165 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5166 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5167 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5168 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5169 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005170
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005171 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5172 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5173 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005174
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005175 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005176
5177
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005178http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5179 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5180 ones).
5181
5182 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5183 no | yes | yes | yes
5184
5185 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5186 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5187 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5188 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5189 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5190 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5191
5192 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5193 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5194 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5195
5196 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5197 below.
5198
5199 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5200 instance.
5201
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005202 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5203 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5204 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5205
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005206 Example:
5207 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5208 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5209 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5210
5211http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5212
5213 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5214 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5215 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5216 example, or to pass some internal information.
5217 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5218 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5219 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5220
5221http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5222
5223 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5224 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5225
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005226http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005227
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005228 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5229 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5230 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5231 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5232 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005233
5234http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5235 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5236
5237 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5238
5239 Example:
5240 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5241
5242 # applied to:
5243 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5244
5245 # outputs:
5246 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5247
5248 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5249
5250http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5251 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5252
5253 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5254
5255 Example:
5256 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5257
5258 # applied to:
5259 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5260
5261 # outputs:
5262 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5263
5264http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5265
5266 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5267 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5268 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5269
5270http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5271 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5272
5273 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5274 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5275 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5276 fallback.
5277
5278 Example:
5279 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5280 http-response set-status 431
5281 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5282 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5283
5284http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5285
5286 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5287 inline.
5288
5289 Arguments:
5290 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5291 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5292 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5293 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5294 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5295 (request and response)
5296 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5297 processing
5298 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5299 processing
5300 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5301 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5302 and '_'.
5303
5304 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5305 followed by some converters.
5306
5307 Example:
5308 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5309
5310http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5311
5312 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5313 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5314 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5315 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5316 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005317 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005318 processing.
5319
5320 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5321 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005322 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005323 rules evaluation.
5324
5325http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5326
5327 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5328 details about <var-name>.
5329
5330 Example:
5331 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5332
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005333
5334http-check comment <string>
5335 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5336 it fails.
5337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5338 yes | no | yes | yes
5339
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005340 Arguments :
5341 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5342 rule fails.
5343
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005344 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5345 user-friendly error reporting.
5346
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005347 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005348 "http-check expect".
5349
5350
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005351http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5352 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005353 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005354 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5356 yes | no | yes | yes
5357
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005358 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005359 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5360
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005361 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005362 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005363
5364 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5365 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5366 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5367 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5368
5369 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5370
5371 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5372
5373 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5374
5375 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5376
5377 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5378
5379 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5380 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5381 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5382 is used.
5383
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005384 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5385 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5386 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5387 haproxy -vv.
5388
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005389 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5390
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005391 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5392 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5393 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5394 different ports or with different servers.
5395
5396 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5397 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5398 the port with a "http-check connect".
5399
5400 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5401 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5402 do.
5403
5404 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5405 unset-var or comment rules.
5406
5407 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005408 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5409 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5410 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5411 option httpchk
5412
5413 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005414 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005415 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005416 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005417 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005418 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005419
5420 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5421
5422 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005423
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005424
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005425http-check disable-on-404
5426 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005428 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005429 Arguments : none
5430
5431 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5432 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5433 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5434 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5435 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5436 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5437 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5438 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005439 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5440 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005441 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5442 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5443 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005444
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005445 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005446
5447
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005448http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005449 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5450 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5451 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005452 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005454 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005455
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005456 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005457 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5458
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005459 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5460 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5461 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5462 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5463 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5464 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5465 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5466 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5467 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5468 result is always conclusive.
5469
5470 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5471 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5472 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005473 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5474 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005475 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5476 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005477 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5478 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5479 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005480
5481 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5482 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005483 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5484 supported :
5485 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5486 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005487 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5488 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5489 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5490 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5491 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005492
5493 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5494 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005495 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5496 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5497 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5498 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005499 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5500
5501 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5502 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5503 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5504 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5505
5506 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5507 informational message reported in logs if an error
5508 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5509 log-format string.
5510
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005511 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005512 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5513 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005514 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5515 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5516 details on the supported keywords.
5517
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005518 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5519 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5520 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5521 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005522
5523 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5524 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5525 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5526 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5527 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5528
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005529 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5530 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5531 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5532 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5533 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5534 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5535 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005536
5537 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005538 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005539 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5540 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5541 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5542 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5543
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005544 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5545 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005546 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5547 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5548 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5549 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5550 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5551 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5552 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5553 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005554 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5555 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5556 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5557 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5558 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5559 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5560 insensitive on the header names.
5561
5562 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5563 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5564 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5565 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5566 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5567 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005568
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005569 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005570 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005571 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5572 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5573 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5574 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5575 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005576 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005577 trace).
5578
5579 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005580 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005581 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5582 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5583 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5584 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5585 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005586 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005587
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005588 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5589 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5590 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5591 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5592 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5593 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5594
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005595 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005596 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005597 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5598 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5599 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5600 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5601 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5602 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5603
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005604 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5605 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5606 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5607 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5608 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005609
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005610 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5611 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5612
5613 Examples :
5614 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005615 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005616
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005617 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5618 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5619
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005620 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005621 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005622
5623 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005624 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005625
5626 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005627 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005628
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005629 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005630 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005631
5632
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005633http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005634 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5635 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005636 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5637 health checks.
5638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5639 yes | no | yes | yes
5640 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005641 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5642
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005643 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5644 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5645 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5646 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5647 to invent non-standard ones.
5648
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005649 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5650 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5651 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5652 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5653
5654 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5655 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5656 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5657 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005658
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005659 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005660 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005661 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005662 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5663 to add it.
5664
5665 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5666 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5667 to the log-format rules.
5668
5669 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5670 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5671 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005672
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005673 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5674 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5675 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5676 request.
5677
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005678 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5679 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5680 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005681 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5682 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5683 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5684 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005685 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005686
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005687 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005688 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5689 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005690
5691 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5692 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5693 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5694 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5695 configured request authority.
5696
5697 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5698 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005699
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005700 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005701
5702
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005703http-check send-state
5704 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5706 yes | no | yes | yes
5707 Arguments : none
5708
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005709 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005710 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005711 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5712 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5713 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005714
5715 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5716 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5717 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5718 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5719 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005720 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5721 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5722 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5723
5724 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5725 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5726 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5727
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005728 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5729 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5730 checked in multiple backends.
5731
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005732 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005733 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5734
5735 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5736 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5737 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5738 one fails.
5739
5740 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5741 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5742 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5743
5744 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5745 server's queue.
5746
5747 Example of a header received by the application server :
5748 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5749 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5750
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005751 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5752 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005753
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005754
5755http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005756 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005757 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5758 yes | no | yes | yes
5759
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005760 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005761 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5762 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5763 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5764 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5765 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5766 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5767 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5768 and '-'.
5769
5770 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5771
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005772 Examples :
5773 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005774
5775
5776http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005777 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005778 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5779 yes | no | yes | yes
5780
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005781 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005782 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5783 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5784 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5785 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5786 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5787 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5788 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5789 and '-'.
5790
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005791 Examples :
5792 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005793
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005794
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005795http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5796 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5797 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5798 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5799 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5801 yes | yes | yes | yes
5802 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005803 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005804 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005805 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005806 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005807
5808 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5809 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5810 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5811 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5812
5813 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5814 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5815 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5816 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5817
5818 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5819 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5820 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5821 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5822 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5823 chroot is performed.
5824
5825 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5826 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5827 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5828 considered.
5829
5830 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5831 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5832 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5833 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5834 considered as a raw string.
5835
5836 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5837 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5838 "content-type".
5839
5840 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5841 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5842 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5843 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5844 evaluated as a log-format string.
5845
5846 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5847 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5848 argument to "content-type".
5849
5850 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5851 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5852 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5853 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5854
5855 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5856 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5857 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5858 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5859 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5860 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5861 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5862 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5863
5864 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5865 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5866 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5867
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005868 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5869 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5870 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5871 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5872 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5873
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005874 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5875 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5876
5877
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005878http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005879 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5880
5881 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5882 no | yes | yes | yes
5883
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005884 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5885 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5886 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5887 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5888 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005889
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005890 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5891 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005892
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005893 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005894
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005895 Example:
5896 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5897 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5898 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005899
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005900 http-request allow if nagios
5901 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5902 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5903 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005904
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005905 Example:
5906 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5907 acl add path /addacl
5908 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005909
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005910 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005911
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005912 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5913 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005914
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005915 Example:
5916 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5917 acl setmap path /setmap
5918 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005919
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005920 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005921
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005922 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5923 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005924
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005925 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5926 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005927
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005928http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005929
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005930 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5931 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5932 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5933 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5934 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5935 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5936 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5937 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005938
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005939http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005940
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005941 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5942 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5943 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5944 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5945 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5946 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5947 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5948 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005949
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005950http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005951
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005952 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5953 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005954
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005955
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005956http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005957
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005958 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5959 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5960 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5961 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5962 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005963
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005964 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5965 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5966 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5967 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5968 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5969 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5970 instead.
5971
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005972 Example:
5973 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5974 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005975
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005976http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005977
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005978 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005979
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005980http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5981 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005982
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005983 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5984 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5985 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5986 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5987 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5988 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5989 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5990 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5991 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005992
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005993 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5994 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5995 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005996 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5997
5998 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5999 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6000 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6001 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006002
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006003http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006004
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006005 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6006 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6007 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6008 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6009 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6010 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006011
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006012http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006013
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006014 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6015 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6016 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6017 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6018 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006019
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006020http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006021
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006022 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6023 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6024 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6025 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6026 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6027 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006028
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006029http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6030http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6031 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6032 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6033 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6034 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006035
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006036 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6037 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6038 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006039 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006040 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6041 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6042 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006043 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006044 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006045
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006046http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6047 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6048 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6049 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6050
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006051http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6052
6053 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6054 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6055 pointed by <resolvers>.
6056 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6057 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6058 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6059 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6060 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6061 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6062 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6063 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6064 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6065 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6066 to 0.0.0.0.
6067
6068 Example:
6069 resolvers mydns
6070 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6071 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6072 timeout retry 1s
6073 hold valid 10s
6074 hold nx 3s
6075 hold other 3s
6076 hold obsolete 0s
6077 accepted_payload_size 8192
6078
6079 frontend fe
6080 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6081 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6082 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6083
6084 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6085 # which mean DNS resolution error
6086 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6087
6088 default_backend be
6089
6090 backend b_503
6091 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6092 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6093 # 503 error page to end users
6094
6095 backend be
6096 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6097 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6098 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6099 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6100 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6101
6102 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6103 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6104
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006105http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6106
6107 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6108 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6109 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6110 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006111 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6112 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006113
6114 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6115
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006116http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006117http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006118http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006119http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006120http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006121http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006122http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006123http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6124http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006125
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006126 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6127
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006128 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006129 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6130 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6131 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6132 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006133
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006134 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6135 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6136 the supported backend.
6137
6138 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6139 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6140 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6141 number of segments in the path.
6142
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006143 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6144 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6145 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6146 when improperly combined.
6147
6148 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6149 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6150 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6151 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6152 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6153
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006154 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006155
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006156 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6157
6158 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6159 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6160
6161 Example:
6162 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6163
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006164 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6165
6166 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6167 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6168
6169 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6170 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6171
6172 Example:
6173 - /#foo -> /
6174
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006175 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6176 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006177
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006178 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6179 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6180
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006181 Example:
6182 - /. -> /
6183 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6184 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6185 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006186
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006187 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6188 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6189
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006190 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006191 their preceding segment.
6192
6193 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6194 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6195
6196 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6197 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006198
6199 Example:
6200 - /foo/../ -> /
6201 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6202 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6203 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006204 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006205 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006206 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006207
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006208 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6209 removed as well:
6210
6211 Example:
6212 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6213 - /bar/../../ -> /
6214
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006215 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6216 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006217
6218 Example:
6219 - // -> /
6220 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6221
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006222 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6223 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6224
6225 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6226 ".", "_", and "~".
6227
6228 Example:
6229 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6230 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6231 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6232 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6233
6234 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6235 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6236
6237 Example:
6238 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6239 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6240
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006241 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006242 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006243
6244 Example:
6245 - /%6f -> /%6F
6246 - /%zz -> /%zz
6247
6248 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6249 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6250
6251 Example:
6252 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6253
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006254 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006255 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6256 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6257
6258 Example:
6259 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6260 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6261 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6262
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006263http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006264
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006265 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6266 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6267 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6268 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6269 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006270
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006271http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006272
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006273 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6274 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6275 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6276 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006278http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6279 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006280
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006281 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006282 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6283 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6284 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6285 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6286 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006287
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006288 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6289 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6290 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6291 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6292 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006293
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006294 Example:
6295 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6296
6297 # applied to:
6298 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6299
6300 # outputs:
6301 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6302
6303 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006304
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006305 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6306
6307 # applied to:
6308 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006309
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006310 # outputs:
6311 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006312
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006313http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6314 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6315
6316 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6317 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006318 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6319 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6320 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006321
6322 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6323 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6324 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6325
6326 Example:
6327 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6328 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6329
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006330 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6331 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6332 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6333 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6334
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006335http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6336 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6337
6338 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6339 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6340 query-string are replaced.
6341
6342 Example:
6343 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6344 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6345
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006346http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6347 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6348
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006349 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6350 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6351 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6352 against.
6353
6354 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6355 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6356 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006357
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006358 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6359 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6360 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6361 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6362 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6363 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6364 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6365 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6366 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006367 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6368 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006369
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006370 Example:
6371 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6372 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006373
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006374 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6375 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006377http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6378 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006379
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006380 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6381 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6382 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6383 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006384
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006385 Example:
6386 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006387
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006388 # applied to:
6389 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006390
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006391 # outputs:
6392 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006393
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006394http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6395 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6396 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006397 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006398 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6399
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006400 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006401 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6402 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006403 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006404 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006405 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006406 are followed to create the response :
6407
6408 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6409 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6410 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6411 ignored.
6412
6413 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6414 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006415 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006416 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6417 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006418
6419 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6420 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6421 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006422 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006423 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006424
6425 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6426 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6427 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006428 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006429 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006430 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006431
6432 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6433 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6434 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6435 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6436 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6437 as a raw content.
6438
6439 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6440 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6441 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6442 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6443 considered as a raw string.
6444
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006445 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006446 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6447 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6448 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6449
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006450 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6451 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006452 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006453
6454 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6455
6456 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006457 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006458 if { path /ping }
6459
6460 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6461 if { path /favicon.ico }
6462
6463 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6464 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6465 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6466
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006467http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6468
6469 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6470 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6471 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6472 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6473 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6474 at this index.
6475 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6476 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6477
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006478http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6479http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006480
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006481 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6482 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6483 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006484
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006485http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6486 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6487 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6488 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6489 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6490 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6491 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6492 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6493 at this index.
6494 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6495 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6496
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006497http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6498 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006499
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006500 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6501 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6502 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6503 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006505http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006507 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6508 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6509 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6510 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6511 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006513 Arguments:
6514 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6515 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006516
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006517 Example:
6518 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6519 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006520
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006521 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6522 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006523
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006524http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006526 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6527 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6528 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006529
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006530 Arguments:
6531 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6532 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006533
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006534 Example:
6535 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6536 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006537
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006538 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6539 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6540 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006542http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006544 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6545 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6546 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6547 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6548 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006549
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006550 Example:
6551 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6552 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6553 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6554 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6555 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6556 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6557 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6558 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6559 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006561http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006562
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006563 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6564 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6565 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6566 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6567 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006568
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006569http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6570 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006572 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6573 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6574 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6575 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6576 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6577 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6578 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6579 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6580 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006582http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006583
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01006584 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
6585 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6586 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
6587 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
6588 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
6589 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
6590 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01006591 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
6592 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006594http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006596 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6597 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6598 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006600http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006602 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6603 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6604 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6605 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6606 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6607 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6608 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6609 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006611http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006612
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006613 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6614 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6615 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6616 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6617 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6618 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006620 Example :
6621 # prepend the host name before the path
6622 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006623
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006624http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6625
6626 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6627 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6628 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006630http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006632 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6633 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6634 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6635 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6636 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006638http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006640 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6641 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6642 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6643 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6644 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6645 values have higher priority.
6646 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6647 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6648 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6649 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6650 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006652http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006654 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6655 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6656 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6657 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6658 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6659 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6660 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006662 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006663
6664 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006665 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6666 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006667
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006668http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6669 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6670 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6671 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006672 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6673 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006674
6675 Arguments :
6676 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6677 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006678
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006679 See also "option forwardfor".
6680
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006681 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006682 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6683 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6684
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006685 # After the masking this will track connections
6686 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6687 http-request track-sc0 src
6688
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006689 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6690 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6691
6692http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6693
6694 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6695 expression.
6696
6697 Arguments:
6698 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6699 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006700
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006701 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006702 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6703 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6704
6705 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6706 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6707 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6708
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006709http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006710 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6711
6712 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6713 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6714 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6715 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6716 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6717
6718 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6719 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6720 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6721 results.
6722
6723 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006724 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6725 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006726
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006727http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6728
6729 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6730 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6731 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6732 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6733 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6734 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6735 information from the request.
6736
6737 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6738
6739http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6740
6741 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6742 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6743 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6744 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6745 path and the query string.
6746 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6747
6748http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6749
6750 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6751 inline.
6752
6753 Arguments:
6754 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6755 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6756 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6757 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6758 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6759 (request and response)
6760 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6761 processing
6762 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6763 processing
6764 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6765 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6766 and '_'.
6767
6768 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6769 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006770
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006771 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006772 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006773
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006774http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6775 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006776
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006777 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6778 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6779 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6780 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6781 agent name must be used.
6782
6783 Arguments:
6784 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6785
6786 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6787 configuration.
6788
6789http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6790
6791 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6792 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6793 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6794 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6795 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6796 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6797 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6798 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6799 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6800 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6801 action.
6802 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6803 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6804 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6805 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6806 you fully understand how it works.
6807
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006808http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6809
6810 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6811 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6812 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6813 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6814 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006815 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006816 processing.
6817
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006818 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006819 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6820 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6821 rules evaluation.
6822
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006823http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6824http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6825 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6826 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6827 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6828 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006829
6830 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6831 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6832 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006833 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6834 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6835 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6836 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6837 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6838 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006839 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006840 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6841 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6842 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006843 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006844 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6845 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6846 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6847 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6848 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006849
6850http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6851http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6852http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6853
6854 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6855 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6856 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6857 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006858 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006859 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6860 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6861 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6862 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6863 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6864 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6865 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6866
6867 Arguments :
6868 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6869 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6870 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6871 select which table entry to update the counters.
6872
6873 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6874 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6875 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6876 that table until the session ends.
6877
6878 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6879 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6880 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6881 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6882 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6883 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6884 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6885 useful information.
6886
6887 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6888 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6889 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6890 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6891 checks that make use of it.
6892
6893http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6894
6895 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006896
6897 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006898 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006899
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006900http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6901
6902 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6903 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6904 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6905 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6906 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6907 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6908
6909 Arguments :
6910 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6911
6912 Example:
6913 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6914
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006915http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6916 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6917
6918 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6919 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6920 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6921 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6922 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6923 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6924 http-buffer-request".
6925
6926 Arguments :
6927
6928 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6929 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6930
6931 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006932 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006933 bytes.
6934
6935 Example:
6936 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6937
6938 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6939
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006940http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006941
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006942 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6943 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6944 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006945
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006947http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006948 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6949
6950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6951 no | yes | yes | yes
6952
6953 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6954 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6955 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6956 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6957 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6958 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006960 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6961 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006962
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006963 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006964
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006965 Example:
6966 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006968 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006969
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006970 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6971 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006972
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006973 Example:
6974 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006976 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006978 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6979 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006980
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006981 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6982 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006984http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006985
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006986 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6987 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6988 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6989 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6990 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6991 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6992 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6993 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006994
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006995http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006996
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006997 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6998 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6999 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7000 example, or to pass some internal information.
7001 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7002 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7003 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007004
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007005http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007006
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007007 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7008 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007009
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007010http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007011
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007012 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007013
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007014http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007016 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7017 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7018 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7019 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7020 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7021 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7022 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007023
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007024 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7025 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7026 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7027 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7028 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007029
7030 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7031 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7032 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7033 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007034
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007035http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007036
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007037 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7038 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7039 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7040 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7041 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7042 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007043
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007044http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007045
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007046 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7047 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7048 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7049 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7050 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007052http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007054 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7055 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7056 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7057 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7058 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7059 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007060
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007061http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7062http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7063 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7064 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7065 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7066 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007067
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007068 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7069 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7070 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007071 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007072 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7073 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7074 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007075 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007076 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007077
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007078http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007079
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007080 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7081 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7082 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7083 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7084 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7085 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007087http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7088 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007089
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007090 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7091 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007092
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007093 Example:
7094 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007096 # applied to:
7097 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007098
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007099 # outputs:
7100 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007101
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007102 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007103
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007104http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7105 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007106
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007107 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007108 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007109
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007110 Example:
7111 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007112
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007113 # applied to:
7114 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007116 # outputs:
7117 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007118
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007119http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7120 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7121 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007122 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007123 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7124
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007125 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007126 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7127 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007128 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007129 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007130 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007131 are followed to create the response :
7132
7133 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7134 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7135 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7136 ignored.
7137
7138 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7139 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007140 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007141 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7142 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007143
7144 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7145 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7146 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007147 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007148 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007149
7150 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7151 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7152 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007153 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007154 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007155 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007156
7157 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7158 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7159 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7160 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7161 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7162 as a raw content.
7163
7164 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7165 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7166 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7167 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7168 considered as a raw string.
7169
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007170 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7171 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7172 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7173 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7174
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007175 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7176 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007177 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007178
7179 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7180
7181 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007182 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007183 if { status eq 404 }
7184
7185 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7186 string "This is the end !" \
7187 if { status eq 500 }
7188
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007189http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7190
7191 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7192 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7193 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7194 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7195 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7196 at this index.
7197 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7198 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7199
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007200http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7201http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007202
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007203 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7204 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7205 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007206
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007207http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7208 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7209
7210 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7211 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7212 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7213 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7214 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7215 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7216 at this index.
7217 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7218 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7219
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007220http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7221 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007222
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007223 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7224 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7225 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7226 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007227
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007228http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7229 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007230
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007231 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7232 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7233 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7234 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7235 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007236
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007237 Arguments:
7238 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007239
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007240 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7241 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007242
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007243http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007244
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007245 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7246 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7247 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007248
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007249http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7250
7251 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7252 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7253 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7254 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7255 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7256
7257http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7258
7259 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7260 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7261 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7262 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7263 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7264 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7265 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7266 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7267 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7268
7269http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7270
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007271 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7272 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7273 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7274 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
7275 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7276 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7277 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007278 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7279 and OpenBSD.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007280
7281http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7282
7283 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7284 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7285 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7286 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7287 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7288 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7289 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7290 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7291
7292http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7293 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7294
7295 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7296 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7297 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7298 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007299
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007300 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007301 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7302 http-response set-status 431
7303 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7304 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007305
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007306http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007307
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007308 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7309 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7310 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7311 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7312 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7313 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7314 based on some information from the request.
7315
7316 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7317
7318http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7319
7320 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7321 inline.
7322
7323 Arguments:
7324 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7325 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7326 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7327 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7328 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7329 (request and response)
7330 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7331 processing
7332 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7333 processing
7334 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7335 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7336 and '_'.
7337
7338 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7339 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007340
7341 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007342 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007343
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007344http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007345
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007346 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7347 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7348 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7349 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7350 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7351 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7352 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7353 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7354 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7355 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7356 action.
7357 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7358 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7359 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7360 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7361 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007362
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007363http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7364
7365 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7366 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7367 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7368 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7369 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007370 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007371 processing.
7372
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007373 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007374 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007375 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007376 rules evaluation.
7377
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007378http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7379http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7380http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007381
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007382 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7383 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7384 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7385 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7386 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007387 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007388
7389http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7390
7391 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7392 about <var-name>.
7393
7394 Example:
7395 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7396
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007397http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7398 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7399
7400 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7401 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7402 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7403 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7404 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7405 buffer is full.
7406
7407 Arguments :
7408
7409 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7410 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7411
7412 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007413 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007414 bytes.
7415
7416 Example:
7417 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007418
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007419http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7420 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7421
7422 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7423 yes | no | yes | yes
7424
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007425 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007426 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7427 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7428 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007429
7430 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7431
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007432 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7433 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7434 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7435 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7436 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7437 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7438 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007439 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007440 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7441 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007442
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007443 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7444 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7445 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7446 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7447 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7448 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7449 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007450 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7451 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7452 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7453 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7454 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7455 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007456
7457 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7458 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7459 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7460 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7461 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7462 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7463 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7464 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007465 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007466 downsides of rare connection failures.
7467
7468 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7469 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7470 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7471 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7472 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7473 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007474 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007475 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7476 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7477 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7478 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7479 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7480
7481 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007482 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7483 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7484 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7485 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007486
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007487 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7488 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007489
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007490 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007491
7492 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7493 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7494 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7495
7496 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7497
7498
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007499http-send-name-header [<header>]
7500 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007501 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7502 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007503 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007504 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7505
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007506 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7507 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7508 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7509 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7510 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7511 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7512 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7513 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7514 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7515 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7516 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7517 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7518 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7519 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7520 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7521 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007522
7523 See also : "server"
7524
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007525id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007526 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7528 no | yes | yes | yes
7529 Arguments : none
7530
7531 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7532 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7533 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007534
7535
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007536ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7537 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7538 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007539 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007540
7541 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7542 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7543 and running).
7544
7545 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7546 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7547 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007548 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007549 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7550
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007551 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7552 "unless" condition is met.
7553
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007554 Example:
7555 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7556 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7557 ignore-persist if url_static
7558
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007559 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7560
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007561load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7562 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7563 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7564 yes | no | yes | yes
7565
7566 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7567 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7568 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007569 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007570 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007571 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7572 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7573 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7574
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007575 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007576 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007577 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007578
7579 Arguments:
7580 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7581 named "server-state-file".
7582
7583 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7584 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7585 name is used as a file name.
7586
7587 none don't load any stat for this backend
7588
7589 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007590 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7591 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7592 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007593 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007594 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007595
7596 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7597 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7598
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007599 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007600
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007601 global
7602 stats socket /tmp/socket
7603 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007604
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007605 defaults
7606 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007607
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007608 backend bk
7609 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7610 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007611
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007612
7613 Then one can run :
7614
7615 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7616
7617 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7618
7619 1
7620 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7621 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7622 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7623
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007624 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007625
7626 global
7627 stats socket /tmp/socket
7628 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7629
7630 defaults
7631 load-server-state-from-file local
7632
7633 backend bk
7634 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7635 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7636
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007637
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007638 Then one can run :
7639
7640 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7641
7642 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7643
7644 1
7645 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7646 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7647 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7648
7649 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7650 "show servers state"
7651
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007652
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007653log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007654log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007655 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007656no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007657 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7659 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007660
7661 Prefix :
7662 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7663 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7664 prefix does not allow arguments.
7665
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007666 Arguments :
7667 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7668 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7669 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7670 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7671 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7672 parameter.
7673
7674 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7675 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7676
7677 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7678 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7679 standard syslog port).
7680
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007681 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7682 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7683 standard syslog port).
7684
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007685 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7686 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7687 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007688 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007689
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007690 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7691 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7692 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7693 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7694 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7695 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7696 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7697 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7698 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7699 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7700 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7701 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007702 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007703 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7704 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7705 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007706 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7707 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007708
7709 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7710 and "fd@2", see above.
7711
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007712 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7713 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7714 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7715 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7716 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7717 having the logs instantly available.
7718
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007719 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7720 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7721 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7722
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007723 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7724 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007725
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007726 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7727 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7728 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7729 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7730 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7731 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7732 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7733 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7734 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7735 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007736 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007737
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007738 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7739 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7740 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7741 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7742 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7743
7744 <sample_size>
7745 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7746 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7747 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7748 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7749 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7750
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007751 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7752 one of the following :
7753
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007754 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7755 field is stripped. This is the default.
7756 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7757 rfc3164.
7758
7759 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007760 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7761
7762 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7763 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7764
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007765 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7766 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7767 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7768 designed to be used with a local log server.
7769
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007770 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7771 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7772 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7773 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7774 systemd logger consumes.
7775
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007776 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7777 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7778 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7779 used with a local log server.
7780
7781 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7782 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7783 designed to be used with a local log server.
7784
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007785 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7786 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7787 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7788 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7789
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007790 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7791
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007792 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7793 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7794 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7795
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007796 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7797 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7798 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7799 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007800
7801 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7802 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7803 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007804 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7805 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7806 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7807 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7808 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007809
7810 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7811
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007812 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7813 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7814 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007815
7816 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7817 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7818 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7819 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7820
7821 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7822 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007823
7824 Example :
7825 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007826 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7827 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7828 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007829 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007830 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7831 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007832 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007834
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007835log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007836 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7837 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7838 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007839
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007840 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7841 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7842 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7843 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7844 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02007845 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
7846 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007847
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02007848 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
7849 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007850
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007851log-format-sd <string>
7852 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7853 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7854 yes | yes | yes | no
7855
7856 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7857 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7858 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7859 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7860 which covers the log format string in depth.
7861
7862 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7863 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7864
7865 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7866 log format to "rfc5424".
7867
7868 Example :
7869 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7870
7871
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007872log-tag <string>
7873 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7874 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7875 yes | yes | yes | yes
7876
7877 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7878 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007879 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007880 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7881 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7882 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7883 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7884 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7885 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007886
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007887max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7888 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7889 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7890 yes | no | yes | yes
7891
7892 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7893 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7894 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7895 servers.
7896
7897 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007898 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007899 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7900 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7901 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007902 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007903 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7904 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7905 picking a different server.
7906
7907 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7908 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7909 even if they have to be queued.
7910
7911 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7912 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7913
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007914max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7915 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7916 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7917 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007918
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007919maxconn <conns>
7920 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7922 yes | yes | yes | no
7923 Arguments :
7924 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7925 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7926 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7927 closes.
7928
7929 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007930 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007931 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7932 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007933 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7934 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7935 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7936 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007937
7938 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7939 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7940 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7941
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007942 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7943 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007944
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007945 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7946
7947
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007948mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007949 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7951 yes | yes | yes | yes
7952 Arguments :
7953 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7954 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7955 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7956 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7957
7958 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7959 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7960 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7961 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7962 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7963
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007964 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7965 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7966 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007967
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007968 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007969 defaults http_instances
7970 mode http
7971
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007972
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007973monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007974 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7976 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007977 Arguments :
7978 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7979 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007980 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007981 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7982 backend and its backup.
7983
7984 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7985 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7986 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7987 servers in a list of backends.
7988
7989 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7990 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7991 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007992 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007993 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7994 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007995 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007996 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7997 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007998
7999 Example:
8000 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008001 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008002 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8003 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8004 monitor-uri /site_alive
8005 monitor fail if site_dead
8006
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008007 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008008
8009
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008010monitor-uri <uri>
8011 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8013 yes | yes | yes | no
8014 Arguments :
8015 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8016 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8017
8018 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8019 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8020 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8021 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8022 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8023 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8024 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8025 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8026
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008027 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008028 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8029 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8030 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8031 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8032 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8033 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008034
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008035 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8036 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8037 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8038 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8039
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008040 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008041 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008042 frontend www
8043 mode http
8044 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8045
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008046 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008047
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008048
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008049option abortonclose
8050no option abortonclose
8051 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8053 yes | no | yes | yes
8054 Arguments : none
8055
8056 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8057 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8058 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8059 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008060 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008061 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8062 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8063 encountered while delivering the response.
8064
8065 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8066 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8067 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8068 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8069 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8070 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008071 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008072 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008073 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008074 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8075 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8076 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8077
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008078 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8079 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008080 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8081 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8082 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8083 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8084 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8085 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008086 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008087
8088 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8089 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8090
8091 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8092
8093
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008094option accept-invalid-http-request
8095no option accept-invalid-http-request
8096 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8098 yes | yes | yes | no
8099 Arguments : none
8100
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008101 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008102 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008103 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008104 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8105 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8106 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8107 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8108 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008109 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8110 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8111 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8112 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008113 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008114 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008115 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8116 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8117 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008118
8119 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8120 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8121 been confirmed.
8122
8123 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8124 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008125 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8126 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008127 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8128
8129 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8130 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8131
8132 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8133 stats socket.
8134
8135
8136option accept-invalid-http-response
8137no option accept-invalid-http-response
8138 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8140 yes | no | yes | yes
8141 Arguments : none
8142
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008143 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008144 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008145 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008146 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8147 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8148 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8149 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8150 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008151 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8152 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8153 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008154
8155 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8156 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8157 been confirmed.
8158
8159 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8160 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8161 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8162 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8163
8164 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8165 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8166
8167 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8168 stats socket.
8169
8170
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008171option allbackups
8172no option allbackups
8173 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8175 yes | no | yes | yes
8176 Arguments : none
8177
8178 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8179 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8180 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8181 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8182 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8183 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8184 order between the backup servers anymore.
8185
8186 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8187 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8188
8189 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8190 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8191
8192
8193option checkcache
8194no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008195 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8197 yes | no | yes | yes
8198 Arguments : none
8199
8200 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8201 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008202 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008203 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8204 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008205 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008206
8207 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008208 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008209 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008210 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8211 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008212 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008213 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008214 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8215 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008216 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008217 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8218 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008219 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008220 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8221 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8222 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8223 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8224 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8225 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8226 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8227 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8228 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8229
8230 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008231 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8232 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8233 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8234 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008235
8236 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8237 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008238 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008239 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008240
8241 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8242 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8243
8244
8245option clitcpka
8246no option clitcpka
8247 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8249 yes | yes | yes | no
8250 Arguments : none
8251
8252 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8253 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008254 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008255 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8256
8257 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8258 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8259 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8260 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8261
8262 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8263 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8264 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8265 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8266 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8267
8268 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8269
8270 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8271 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8272 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8273
8274 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8275 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8276
8277 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8278
8279
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008280option contstats
8281 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8283 yes | yes | yes | no
8284 Arguments : none
8285
8286 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8287 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8288 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008289 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008290 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8291 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8292 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8293 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8294 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008295
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008296option disable-h2-upgrade
8297no option disable-h2-upgrade
8298 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8299 connection.
8300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8301 yes | yes | yes | no
8302 Arguments : none
8303
8304 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8305 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8306 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8307 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008308 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8309 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8310 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8311 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8312 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8313 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008314
8315 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8316 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008317
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008318option dontlog-normal
8319no option dontlog-normal
8320 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8322 yes | yes | yes | no
8323 Arguments : none
8324
8325 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8326 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8327 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8328 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8329 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8330 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8331 logged.
8332
8333 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8334 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8335 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008337 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008338 logging.
8339
8340
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008341option dontlognull
8342no option dontlognull
8343 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8345 yes | yes | yes | no
8346 Arguments : none
8347
8348 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8349 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8350 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8351 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8352 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8353 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008354 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8355 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8356 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008357
8358 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008359 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008360 would not be logged.
8361
8362 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8363 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8364
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008365 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008366 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008367
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008368
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008369option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008370 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8372 yes | yes | yes | yes
8373 Arguments :
8374 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8375 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008376 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008377 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008378
8379 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8380 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8381 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8382 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8383 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8384 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8385 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008386 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8387 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8388 possible that the client has already brought one.
8389
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008390 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008391 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008392 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008393 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008394 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008395 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008396
8397 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8398 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8399 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8400 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8401 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8402 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008403 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008404
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008405 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8406 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008407 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008408 are under the control of the end-user.
8409
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008410 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008411 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8412 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008413 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8414 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8415 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008416
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008417 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008418 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8419 frontend www
8420 mode http
8421 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8422
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008423 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8424 backend www
8425 mode http
8426 option forwardfor header X-Client
8427
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008428 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008429 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008430
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008431
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008432option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8433no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8434 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8436 yes | yes | yes | no
8437 Arguments : none
8438
8439 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8440 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8441 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8442 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8443 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8444 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8445 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8446
8447 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8448 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8449 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8450 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8451 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8452 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8453 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8454 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8455 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8456 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8457
8458 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8459
8460 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8461 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8462
8463 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8464 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8465
8466
8467option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8468no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8469 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8471 yes | no | yes | yes
8472 Arguments : none
8473
8474 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8475 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8476 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8477 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8478 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8479 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8480 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8481
8482 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8483 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8484 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8485 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8486 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8487 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8488 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8489 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8490 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8491 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8492
8493 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8494
8495 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8496 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8497
8498 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8499 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8500
8501
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008502option http-buffer-request
8503no option http-buffer-request
8504 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8506 yes | yes | yes | yes
8507 Arguments : none
8508
8509 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8510 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8511 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8512 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8513 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8514 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008515 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8516 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8517 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8518 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008519
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008520 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8521 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008522
8523
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008524option http-ignore-probes
8525no option http-ignore-probes
8526 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8528 yes | yes | yes | no
8529 Arguments : none
8530
8531 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8532 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8533 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8534 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8535 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8536 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8537 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8538 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8539 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008540 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8541 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008542 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8543
8544 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8545 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8546 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8547 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8548 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8549 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8550 are often the only way to detect them.
8551
8552 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8553 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8554
8555 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8556
8557
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008558option http-keep-alive
8559no option http-keep-alive
8560 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8562 yes | yes | yes | yes
8563 Arguments : none
8564
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008565 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8566 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008567 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8568 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008569 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8570 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8571 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008572
8573 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8574 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008575 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8576 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8577 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8578 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8579 situations where this option may be useful :
8580
8581 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008582 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008583
8584 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8585 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8586
8587 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8588 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8589 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8590 request.
8591
8592 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8593 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008594 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8595 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8596 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008597
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008598 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8599 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8600 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8601 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8602 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8603 not set.
8604
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008605 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8606 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8607 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008608
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008609 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008610 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008611 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008612
8613
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008614option http-no-delay
8615no option http-no-delay
8616 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8618 yes | yes | yes | yes
8619 Arguments : none
8620
8621 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8622 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8623 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8624 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8625 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8626 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8627 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008628 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008629 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8630 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8631 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8632 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8633 affected.
8634
8635 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8636 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8637 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8638 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8639 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8640 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8641 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8642 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8643 latency environments.
8644
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008645 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8646
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008647
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008648option http-pretend-keepalive
8649no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008650 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008652 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008653 Arguments : none
8654
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008655 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008656 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8657 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8658 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008659 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008660 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8661 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8662 consider the response complete.
8663
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008664 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008665 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008666 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008667 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008668 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008669 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8670
8671 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8672 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8673 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8674 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008675 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8676 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008677 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8678
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008679 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8680 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8681 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8682 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8683 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8684 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008685
8686 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8687 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8688
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008689 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008690 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008691
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008692
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008693option http-server-close
8694no option http-server-close
8695 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8697 yes | yes | yes | yes
8698 Arguments : none
8699
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008700 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8701 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8702 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8703 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008704 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8705 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8706 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8707 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8708 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8709 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8710 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8711 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8712 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8713 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8714 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008715
8716 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8717 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8718 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8719 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008720 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8721 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008722
8723 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8724 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008725 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8726 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8727 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008728
8729 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8730 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8731
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008732 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8733 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008734
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008735option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008736no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008737 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8739 yes | yes | yes | no
8740 Arguments : none
8741
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008742 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008743 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8744 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8745 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8746 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8747 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008748 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008749
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008750 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008751 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008752 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8753 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8754 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008755
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008756 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8757 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8758 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8759 front of an existing proxy.
8760
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008761 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8762
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008763 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008764
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008765option httpchk
8766option httpchk <uri>
8767option httpchk <method> <uri>
8768option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008769 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8771 yes | no | yes | yes
8772 Arguments :
8773 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8774 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8775 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8776 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8777 ones.
8778
8779 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8780 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8781 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8782
8783 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8784 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8785 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008786 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008787
8788 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8789 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8790 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8791 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8792 the lack of any response.
8793
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008794 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8795 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8796 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8797 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8798
8799 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8800 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8801 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008802
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008803 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8804 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008805 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008806 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008807 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008808
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008809 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8810 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8811 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8812 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8813
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008814 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008815 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8816 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8817 backend https_relay
8818 mode tcp
8819 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8820 http-check send hdr Host www
8821 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008822
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008823 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8824 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8825 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008826
8827
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008828option httpclose
8829no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008830 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8832 yes | yes | yes | yes
8833 Arguments : none
8834
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008835 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8836 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8837 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8838 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008839 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008840
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008841 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8842 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008843 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008844 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8845 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008846
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008847 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8848 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8849 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008850
8851 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8852 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008853 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8854 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8855 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008856
8857 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8858 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8859
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008860 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008861
8862
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008863option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008864 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008866 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008867 Arguments :
8868 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8869 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8870 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008871 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008872 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008873
8874 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8875 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8876 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8877 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8878 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8879 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8880 ports.
8881
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008882 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8883 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008884
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008885 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8886
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008887 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008888
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008889option httpslog
8890 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
8891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8892 yes | yes | yes | no
8893
8894 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8895 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8896 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8897 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8898 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8899 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
8900 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
8901
8902 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8903
8904 See also : section 8 about logging.
8905
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008906
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008907option independent-streams
8908no option independent-streams
8909 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8911 yes | yes | yes | yes
8912 Arguments : none
8913
8914 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8915 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8916 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8917 receive data or not.
8918
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008919 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008920 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8921 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8922 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8923 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8924 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8925 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8926 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8927 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8928 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8929 socket buffers.
8930
8931 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8932 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8933 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8934 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8935 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8936
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008937 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008938
8939
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008940option ldap-check
8941 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8943 yes | no | yes | yes
8944 Arguments : none
8945
8946 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8947 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8948 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8949 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8950
8951 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8952 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8953
8954 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8955 configure it.
8956
8957 Example :
8958 option ldap-check
8959
8960 See also : "option httpchk"
8961
8962
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008963option external-check
8964 Use external processes for server health checks
8965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8966 yes | no | yes | yes
8967
8968 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8969 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8970 command".
8971
8972 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8973
8974 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8975
8976
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008977option log-health-checks
8978no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008979 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8981 yes | no | yes | yes
8982 Arguments : none
8983
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008984 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8985 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8986 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008987
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008988 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8989 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8990 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8991 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8992 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8993
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008994 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008995 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008996
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008997 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8998 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8999 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009000
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009001
9002option log-separate-errors
9003no option log-separate-errors
9004 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9006 yes | yes | yes | no
9007 Arguments : none
9008
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009009 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009010 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9011 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9012 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9013 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9014 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9015 provides very important information.
9016
9017 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9018 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9019 error logs.
9020
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009021 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009022 logging.
9023
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009024
9025option logasap
9026no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009027 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9029 yes | yes | yes | no
9030 Arguments : none
9031
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009032 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9033 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9034 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9035 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9036
9037 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9038 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9039 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9040 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9041 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009042 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009043 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9044 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9045 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9046 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009047 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009048
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009049 Examples :
9050 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9051 mode http
9052 option httplog
9053 option logasap
9054 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9055
9056 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9057 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9058 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9059 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9060
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009061 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009062 logging.
9063
9064
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009065option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009066 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9068 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009069 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009070 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9071 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009072 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9073 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009074
9075 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9076 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009077 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009078 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009079 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9080 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9081 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009082
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009083 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9084 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9085 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009086
9087 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009088 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009089 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9090 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9091 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9092 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9093 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9094 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9095 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9096
9097 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9098 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009099
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009100 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009101
9102 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9103 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9104 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9105 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009106 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009107 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009108
9109 See also: "option httpchk"
9110
9111
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009112option nolinger
9113no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009114 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009115 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9116 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009117 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009118
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009119 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009120 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9121 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9122 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9123 connections.
9124
9125 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9126 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009127 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9128 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9129 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9130 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9131 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9132 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9133 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9134 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9135 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9136 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9137 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9138 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9139 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009140
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009141 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9142 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9143 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9144 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9145 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009146
9147 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9148 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009149 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009150 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009151 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009152
9153 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9154 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9155
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009156 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9157 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009158
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009159option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9160 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9162 yes | yes | yes | yes
9163 Arguments :
9164 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9165 matching <network>
9166 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9167 header name.
9168
9169 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9170 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9171 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9172 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9173 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9174 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9175 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9176 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9177 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9178 possible that the client has already brought one.
9179
9180 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9181 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9182 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9183 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9184 header and requires different one.
9185
9186 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9187 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9188 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009189 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9190 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9191 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9192 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9193 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009194
9195 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9196 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9197 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9198 both are defined.
9199
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009200 Examples :
9201 # Original Destination address
9202 frontend www
9203 mode http
9204 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9205
9206 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9207 backend www
9208 mode http
9209 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9210
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009211 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009212
9213
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009214option persist
9215no option persist
9216 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9217 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9218 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009219 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009220
9221 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9222 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9223 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9224 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9225 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9226 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9227 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9228 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9229 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9230 redirected to another valid server.
9231
9232 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9233 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9234
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009235 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009236
9237
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009238option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9239 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9241 yes | no | yes | yes
9242 Arguments :
9243 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9244 PostgreSQL server.
9245
9246 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9247 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9248 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9249 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9250
9251 See also: "option httpchk"
9252
9253
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009254option prefer-last-server
9255no option prefer-last-server
9256 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9257 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9258 yes | no | yes | yes
9259 Arguments : none
9260
9261 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009262 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009263 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9264 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009265 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009266 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009267 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009268 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9269 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009270 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009271 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009272 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9273 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9274 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009275 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9276 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9277 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009278
9279 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9280 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9281
9282 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9283
9284
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009285option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009286option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009287no option redispatch
9288 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9289 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9290 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009291 Arguments :
9292 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9293 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9294 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009295 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009296 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009297 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009298 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9299 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9300 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009302
9303 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9304 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9305 be able to access the service anymore.
9306
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009307 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9308 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009309
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009310 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9311 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9312 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9313 following order:
9314
9315 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9316
9317 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9318 list, or
9319
9320 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9321
9322 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9323 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9324
9325 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9326 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9327 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9328 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9329
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009330 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009331 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9332 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009334 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9335 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9336
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009337 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009338
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009339
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009340option redis-check
9341 Use redis health checks for server testing
9342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9343 yes | no | yes | yes
9344 Arguments : none
9345
9346 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9347 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9348 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9349 find the "+PONG" response message.
9350
9351 Example :
9352 option redis-check
9353
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009354 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009355
9356
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009357option smtpchk
9358option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9359 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9361 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009362 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009363 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009364 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009365 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9366
9367 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9368 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9369 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9370
9371 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9372 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9373 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9374 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9375 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9376 dead server.
9377
9378 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9379 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009380 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009381 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9382
9383 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9384 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9385 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9386 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009387 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009388
9389 Example :
9390 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9391
9392 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9393
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009394
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009395option socket-stats
9396no option socket-stats
9397
9398 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9400 yes | yes | yes | no
9401
9402 Arguments : none
9403
9404
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009405option splice-auto
9406no option splice-auto
9407 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9409 yes | yes | yes | yes
9410 Arguments : none
9411
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009412 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009413 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009414 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009415 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009416 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009417 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9418 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9419 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9420 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9421
9422 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9423 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9424 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9425 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9426 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9427 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9428 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9429 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9430 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9431 keyword.
9432
9433 Example :
9434 option splice-auto
9435
9436 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9437 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9438
9439 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9440 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9441
9442
9443option splice-request
9444no option splice-request
9445 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9447 yes | yes | yes | yes
9448 Arguments : none
9449
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009450 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009451 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009452 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9453 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9454 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9455 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9456
9457 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9458
9459 Example :
9460 option splice-request
9461
9462 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9463 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9464
9465 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9466 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9467
9468
9469option splice-response
9470no option splice-response
9471 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9473 yes | yes | yes | yes
9474 Arguments : none
9475
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009476 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009477 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009478 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9479 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9480 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9481 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9482
9483 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9484
9485 Example :
9486 option splice-response
9487
9488 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9489 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9490
9491 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9492 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9493
9494
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009495option spop-check
9496 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9498 no | no | no | yes
9499 Arguments : none
9500
9501 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9502 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9503 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9504 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9505
9506 Example :
9507 option spop-check
9508
9509 See also : "option httpchk"
9510
9511
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009512option srvtcpka
9513no option srvtcpka
9514 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9516 yes | no | yes | yes
9517 Arguments : none
9518
9519 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9520 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009521 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009522 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9523
9524 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9525 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9526 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9527 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9528
9529 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9530 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9531 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9532 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9533 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9534
9535 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9536
9537 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9538 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9539 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9540
9541 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9542 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9543
9544 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9545
9546
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009547option ssl-hello-chk
9548 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9550 yes | no | yes | yes
9551 Arguments : none
9552
9553 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9554 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9555 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9556 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9557 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9558 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9559 hello message.
9560
9561 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9562 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9563 messages, which is appreciable.
9564
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009565 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009566 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9567 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009568
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009569 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9570
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009571
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009572option tcp-check
9573 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9574 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9575 yes | no | yes | yes
9576
9577 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9578 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9579
9580 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9581 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9582 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9583
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009584 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009585 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9586 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9587 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9588 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9589 only.
9590
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009591 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009592 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009593 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9594 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9595 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9596
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009597 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009598 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9599 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009600 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009601 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9602 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9603 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9604 the respective protocols.
9605 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009606 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009607
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009608 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009609
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009610 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9611 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9612 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9613 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009614
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009615 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9616 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9617 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009618
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009619
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009620 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009621 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009622 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009623 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009624
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009625 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009626 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009627 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009628
9629 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9630 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009631 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009632 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009633 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009634 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009635 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009636 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009637 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9638 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009639 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009640 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9641 tcp-check expect string +OK
9642
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009643 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009644 (send many headers before analyzing)
9645 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009646 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009647 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9648 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9649 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9650 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009651 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009652
9653
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009654 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009655
9656
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009657option tcp-smart-accept
9658no option tcp-smart-accept
9659 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9661 yes | yes | yes | no
9662 Arguments : none
9663
9664 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9665 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9666 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9667 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9668 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9669 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9670
9671 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9672 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9673 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9674 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9675
9676 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9677 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9678 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009679 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009680
9681 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9682 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9683 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9684
9685 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9686 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9687 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9688
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009689 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9690
9691
9692option tcp-smart-connect
9693no option tcp-smart-connect
9694 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9696 yes | no | yes | yes
9697 Arguments : none
9698
9699 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9700 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9701 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9702 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9703 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9704
9705 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9706 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9707 complex.
9708
9709 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9710 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9711 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9712
9713 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9714 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9715
9716 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9717
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009718
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009719option tcpka
9720 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9722 yes | yes | yes | yes
9723 Arguments : none
9724
9725 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9726 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009727 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009728 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9729
9730 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9731 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9732 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9733 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9734
9735 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9736 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9737 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9738 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9739 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9740
9741 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9742
9743 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9744 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9745 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9746 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9747 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9748 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9749 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9750 backends.
9751
9752 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9753
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009754
9755option tcplog
9756 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009758 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009759 Arguments : none
9760
9761 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9762 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9763 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9764 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9765 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9766 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9767 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9768 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9769
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009770 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9771
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009772 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009773
9774
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009775option transparent
9776no option transparent
9777 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009779 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009780 Arguments : none
9781
9782 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9783 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9784 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9785 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9786 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9787 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9788 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9789 appropriate server.
9790
9791 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9792 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9793
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009794 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009795 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009796
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009797
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009798external-check command <command>
9799 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9801 yes | no | yes | yes
9802
9803 Arguments :
9804 <command> is the external command to run
9805
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009806 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9807
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009808 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009809
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009810 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9811 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9812 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9813 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9814 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9815 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009816
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009817 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9818
9819 Environment variables :
9820 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9821 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9822
9823 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9824
9825 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9826
9827 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9828 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9829 for a UNIX socket).
9830
9831 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9832
9833 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9834
9835 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9836
9837 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9838
9839 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9840
9841 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9842 socket).
9843
9844 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9845 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9846
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009847 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9848
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009849 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9850 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9851 failed.
9852
9853 Example :
9854 external-check command /bin/true
9855
9856 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9857
9858
9859external-check path <path>
9860 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9862 yes | no | yes | yes
9863
9864 Arguments :
9865 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9866
9867 The default path is "".
9868
9869 Example :
9870 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9871
9872 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9873 "external-check command"
9874
9875
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009876persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009877persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009878 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9880 yes | no | yes | yes
9881 Arguments :
9882 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009883 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9884 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009885
9886 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9887 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009888 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009889 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9890 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9891 forwarded to this server.
9892
9893 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9894 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9895 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009896 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009897 a single "listen" section.
9898
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009899 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9900 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9901 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9902
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009903 Example :
9904 listen tse-farm
9905 bind :3389
9906 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9907 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9908 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9909 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9910 persist rdp-cookie
9911 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009912 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009913 balance rdp-cookie
9914 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9915 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9916
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009917 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9918 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009919
9920
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009921rate-limit sessions <rate>
9922 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9924 yes | yes | yes | no
9925 Arguments :
9926 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9927 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9928
9929 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9930 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9931 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009932 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009933 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9934 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9935
9936 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9937 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9938 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9939 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9940
9941 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9942 listen smtp
9943 mode tcp
9944 bind :25
9945 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009946 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009947
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009948 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9949 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9950 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009951
9952 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9953
9954
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009955redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9956redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9957redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009958 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9960 no | yes | yes | yes
9961
9962 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009963 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009964
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009965 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009966 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009967 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9968 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9969 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009970
9971 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9972 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9973 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9974 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9975 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009976 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9977 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9978 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9979 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009980
9981 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9982 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9983 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9984 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9985 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9986 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009987 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009988 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009989 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9990 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9991 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009992
9993 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009994 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9995 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9996 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009997 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009998 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9999 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10000 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10001 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010002
10003 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010004 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010005
10006 - "drop-query"
10007 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10008 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10009 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10010 with a location-type redirect.
10011
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010012 - "append-slash"
10013 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10014 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10015 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10016 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10017
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010018 - "ignore-empty"
10019 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10020 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10021 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10022 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10023 of known paths using a simple map.
10024
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010025 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10026 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10027 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10028 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10029 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10030 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10031 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10032
10033 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10034 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10035 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10036 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10037 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10038 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10039 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010040
10041 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10042 acl clear dst_port 80
10043 acl secure dst_port 8080
10044 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010045 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010046 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010047 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10048
10049 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010050 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10051 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10052 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010053 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010054
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010055 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10056 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10057 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10058
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010059 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010060 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010061
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010062 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010063 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10064 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10065 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010066
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010067 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10068 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10069 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10070
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010071 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010072
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010073
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010074retries <value>
10075 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10076 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10077 yes | no | yes | yes
10078 Arguments :
10079 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10080 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10081 default value is 3.
10082
10083 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10084 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10085 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10086
10087 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010088 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10089 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010090
10091 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10092 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10093
10094 See also : "option redispatch"
10095
10096
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010097retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010098 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10099 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10100 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010101 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10102 yes | no | yes | yes
10103 Arguments :
10104 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10105 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10106 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10107 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10108
10109 none never retry
10110
10111 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10112 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10113
10114 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10115 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10116 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10117 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10118 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10119 processing the request.
10120
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010121 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10122 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10123 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10124 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10125 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10126 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10127 overflow attack for example).
10128
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010129 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10130 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10131 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10132 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10133 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10134 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10135 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10136 amplify denial of service attacks.
10137
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010138 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10139 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10140 considered to be safe to retry.
10141
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010142 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10143 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10144 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10145 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10146 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010147
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010148 all-retryable-errors
10149 retry request for any error that are considered
10150 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10151 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10152 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10153
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010154 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10155 not cumulative.
10156
10157 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10158 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10159 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10160 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10161
10162 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10163 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10164 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10165 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10166 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10167 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10168 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10169 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10170 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10171 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10172 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10173 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10174
10175 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10176 should not use this directive.
10177
10178 The default is "conn-failure".
10179
10180 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10181
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010182server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010183 Declare a server in a backend
10184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10185 no | no | yes | yes
10186 Arguments :
10187 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010188 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010189 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010190
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010191 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10192 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10193 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10194 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010195 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10196 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010197 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010198 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10199 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010200 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10201 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10202 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10203 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10204 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10205 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10206 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010207 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010208 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10209 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10210 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10211 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10212 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10213 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010214 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10215 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010216 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10217 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010218
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010219 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010220 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10221 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10222 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10223 adding this value to the client's port.
10224
10225 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10226 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010227 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010228
10229 Examples :
10230 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10231 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010232 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010233 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10234 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10235 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010236
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010237 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10238 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10239 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10240 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10241 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10242
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010243 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10244 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010245
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010246server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010247 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010248 this backend.
10249 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10250 no | no | yes | yes
10251
10252 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10253 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10254 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10255 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10256 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010257
10258 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10259 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10260
10261 global
10262 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10263
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010264 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010265 load-server-state-from-file
10266
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010267 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010268 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010269
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010270server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10271 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10272 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10274 no | no | yes | yes
10275
10276 Arguments:
10277 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10278
10279 <num | range>
10280 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10281 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10282 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10283 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10284
10285 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10286
10287 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10288
10289 <params*>
10290 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10291 keyword.
10292
10293 Examples:
10294 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10295 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10296 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10297
10298 # or
10299 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10300
10301 # would be equivalent to:
10302 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10303 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10304 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10305
10306
10307
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010308source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010309source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010310source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010311 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10313 yes | no | yes | yes
10314 Arguments :
10315 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10316 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010317
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010318 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010319 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10320 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10321 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10322 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10323 supported prefixes are :
10324 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10325 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10326 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010327 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010328 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10329 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010330
10331 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10332 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010333 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10334 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10335 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010336
10337 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10338 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10339 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10340 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10341 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10342 <addr>.
10343
10344 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10345 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10346 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10347 port.
10348
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010349 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10350 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10351 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10352 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010353 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010354 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10355 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10356 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10357 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10358 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10359 HTTP header.
10360
10361 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10362 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010363 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010364 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10365 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10366 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10367 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10368 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10369 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10370 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10371
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010372 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10373 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10374 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10375 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10376 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10377 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10378
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010379 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10380 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10381 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10382 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10383
10384 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10385 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10386 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10387 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10388 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10389 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10390
10391 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10392 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10393 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10394 there are two methods :
10395
10396 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10397 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10398 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10399 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10400 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10401 of the client ranges may be used.
10402
10403 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10404 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10405 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10406 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10407 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10408 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10409 same session.
10410
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010411 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10412 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10413 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010414 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010415
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010416 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10417
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010418 Examples :
10419 backend private
10420 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10421 source 192.168.1.200
10422
10423 backend transparent_ssl1
10424 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10425 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10426
10427 backend transparent_ssl2
10428 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10429 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10430 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10431
10432 backend transparent_ssl3
10433 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10434 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10435 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10436
10437 backend transparent_smtp
10438 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10439 # with Tproxy version 4.
10440 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10441
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010442 backend transparent_http
10443 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10444 # proxy.
10445 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10446
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010447 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010448 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10449
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010450
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010451srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10452 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10453 the connection on the server side.
10454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10455 yes | no | yes | yes
10456 Arguments :
10457 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10458
10459 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10460 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010461 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10462 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010463
10464 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10465
10466
10467srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10468 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10469 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10470 server side.
10471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10472 yes | no | yes | yes
10473 Arguments :
10474 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10475 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10476 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10477 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10478
10479 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10480 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010481 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10482 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010483
10484 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10485
10486
10487srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10488 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10490 yes | no | yes | yes
10491 Arguments :
10492 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10493 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10494 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10495 document.
10496
10497 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10498 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010499 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10500 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010501
10502 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10503
10504
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010505stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10506 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010508 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010509
10510 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10511 matched.
10512
10513 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10514 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10515
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010516 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10517 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10518 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10519 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010520
10521 Example :
10522 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10523 backend stats_localhost
10524 stats enable
10525 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10526
10527 Example :
10528 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10529 backend stats_auth
10530 stats enable
10531 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10532 stats admin if TRUE
10533
10534 Example :
10535 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10536 userlist stats-auth
10537 group admin users admin
10538 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10539 group readonly users haproxy
10540 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10541
10542 backend stats_auth
10543 stats enable
10544 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10545 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10546 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10547 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10548
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010549 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10550 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010551
10552
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010553stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10554 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010556 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010557 Arguments :
10558 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10559
10560 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10561
10562 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10563 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10564 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10565 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10566 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10567 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10568
10569 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10570 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10571 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010572 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010573
10574 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10575 report using "stats scope".
10576
10577 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10578 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10579 unobvious parameters.
10580
10581 Example :
10582 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10583 backend public_www
10584 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10585 stats enable
10586 stats hide-version
10587 stats scope .
10588 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010589 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010590 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10591 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10592
10593 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10594 backend private_monitoring
10595 stats enable
10596 stats uri /admin?stats
10597 stats refresh 5s
10598
10599 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10600
10601
10602stats enable
10603 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010605 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010606 Arguments : none
10607
10608 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10609 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10610 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10611 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10612 - stats auth : no authentication
10613 - stats scope : no restriction
10614
10615 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10616 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10617 unobvious parameters.
10618
10619 Example :
10620 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10621 backend public_www
10622 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10623 stats enable
10624 stats hide-version
10625 stats scope .
10626 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010627 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010628 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10629 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10630
10631 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10632 backend private_monitoring
10633 stats enable
10634 stats uri /admin?stats
10635 stats refresh 5s
10636
10637 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10638
10639
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010640stats hide-version
10641 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010643 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010644 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010645
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010646 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10647 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10648 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10649 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10650 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10651 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010653 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10654 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10655 unobvious parameters.
10656
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010657 Example :
10658 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10659 backend public_www
10660 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010661 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010662 stats hide-version
10663 stats scope .
10664 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010665 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010666 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10667 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010668
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010669 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10670 backend private_monitoring
10671 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010672 stats uri /admin?stats
10673 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010674
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010675 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010676
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010677
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010678stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10679 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10680 Access control for statistics
10681
10682 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10683 no | no | yes | yes
10684
10685 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10686 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10687 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10688 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10689 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10690 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10691
10692 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10693 instance.
10694
10695 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10696 about ACL usage.
10697
10698
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010699stats realm <realm>
10700 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010702 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010703 Arguments :
10704 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10705 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10706 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10707
10708 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10709 using a backslash ('\').
10710
10711 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10712 only related to authentication.
10713
10714 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10715 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10716 unobvious parameters.
10717
10718 Example :
10719 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10720 backend public_www
10721 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10722 stats enable
10723 stats hide-version
10724 stats scope .
10725 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010726 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010727 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10728 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10729
10730 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10731 backend private_monitoring
10732 stats enable
10733 stats uri /admin?stats
10734 stats refresh 5s
10735
10736 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10737
10738
10739stats refresh <delay>
10740 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010742 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010743 Arguments :
10744 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10745 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10746 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10747 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10748 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10749 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10750
10751 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10752 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10753 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010754 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010755
10756 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10757 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10758 unobvious parameters.
10759
10760 Example :
10761 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10762 backend public_www
10763 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10764 stats enable
10765 stats hide-version
10766 stats scope .
10767 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010768 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010769 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10770 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10771
10772 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10773 backend private_monitoring
10774 stats enable
10775 stats uri /admin?stats
10776 stats refresh 5s
10777
10778 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10779
10780
10781stats scope { <name> | "." }
10782 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010784 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010785 Arguments :
10786 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10787 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10788 section in which the statement appears.
10789
10790 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10791 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10792 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10793 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10794 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10795 exists.
10796
10797 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10798 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10799 unobvious parameters.
10800
10801 Example :
10802 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10803 backend public_www
10804 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10805 stats enable
10806 stats hide-version
10807 stats scope .
10808 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010809 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010810 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10811 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10812
10813 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10814 backend private_monitoring
10815 stats enable
10816 stats uri /admin?stats
10817 stats refresh 5s
10818
10819 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10820
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010821
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010822stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010823 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010825 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010826
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010827 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010828 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10829
10830 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10831 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10832
10833 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10834 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010835 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010836
10837 Example :
10838 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10839 backend private_monitoring
10840 stats enable
10841 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10842 stats uri /admin?stats
10843 stats refresh 5s
10844
10845 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10846 global section.
10847
10848
10849stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010850 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10852 yes | yes | yes | yes
10853 Arguments : none
10854
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010855 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010856 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10857 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10858 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10859 - IP (socket, server)
10860 - cookie (backend, server)
10861
10862 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10863 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010864 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010865
10866 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10867
10868
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010869stats show-modules
10870 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10872 yes | yes | yes | yes
10873 Arguments : none
10874
10875 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10876 values as a tooltip.
10877
10878 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10879 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10880 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10881
10882 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10883
10884
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010885stats show-node [ <name> ]
10886 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010888 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010889 Arguments:
10890 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10891 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10892
10893 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10894 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010895 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010896
10897 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10898 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10899 unobvious parameters.
10900
10901 Example:
10902 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10903 backend private_monitoring
10904 stats enable
10905 stats show-node Europe-1
10906 stats uri /admin?stats
10907 stats refresh 5s
10908
10909 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10910 section.
10911
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010912
10913stats uri <prefix>
10914 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010916 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010917 Arguments :
10918 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10919 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10920 query string.
10921
10922 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10923 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10924 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10925 possible to reach it in the application.
10926
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010927 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010928 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010929 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10930 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10931 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10932 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10933
10934 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10935 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10936 an address or a port to statistics only.
10937
10938 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10939 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10940 unobvious parameters.
10941
10942 Example :
10943 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10944 backend public_www
10945 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10946 stats enable
10947 stats hide-version
10948 stats scope .
10949 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010950 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010951 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10952 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10953
10954 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10955 backend private_monitoring
10956 stats enable
10957 stats uri /admin?stats
10958 stats refresh 5s
10959
10960 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10961
10962
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010963stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10964 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010966 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010967
10968 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010969 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010970 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010971 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010972 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10973
10974 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10975 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10976 the "stick-table" statement.
10977
10978 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10979 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10980 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10981 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10982 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10983
10984 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10985 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10986 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10987 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10988 transformation rules.
10989
10990 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10991 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10992 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10993 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10994 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10995 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10996 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10997
10998 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10999 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11000 ACL based conditions.
11001
11002 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11003 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11004 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11005 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11006
11007 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11008 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11009 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11010 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11011
11012 Example :
11013 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11014 # last 30 minutes
11015 backend pop
11016 mode tcp
11017 balance roundrobin
11018 stick store-request src
11019 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11020 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11021 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11022
11023 backend smtp
11024 mode tcp
11025 balance roundrobin
11026 stick match src table pop
11027 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11028 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11029
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011030 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11031 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011032
11033
11034stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11035 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11037 no | no | yes | yes
11038
11039 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11040 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11041 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11042 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11043
11044 Examples :
11045 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011046 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011047
11048 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11049 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11050 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11051
11052
11053 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11054 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11055 backend http
11056 mode http
11057 balance roundrobin
11058 stick on src table https
11059 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11060 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11061 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11062
11063 backend https
11064 mode tcp
11065 balance roundrobin
11066 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11067 stick on src
11068 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11069 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11070
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011071 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011072
11073
11074stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11075 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11077 no | no | yes | yes
11078
11079 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011080 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011081 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011082 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011083 server is selected.
11084
11085 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11086 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11087 the "stick-table" statement.
11088
11089 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11090 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11091 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11092 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11093 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11094 address.
11095
11096 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11097 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11098 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11099 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11100 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11101 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11102 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11103 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11104 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11105 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11106
11107 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11108 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11109 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11110 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11111 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11112 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11113 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11114
11115 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11116 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11117 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11118 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11119
11120 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11121 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11122 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11123 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11124 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11125 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011126 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11127 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11128 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11129 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11130 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11131 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011132
11133 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11134 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11135 the request.
11136
11137 Example :
11138 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11139 # last 30 minutes
11140 backend pop
11141 mode tcp
11142 balance roundrobin
11143 stick store-request src
11144 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11145 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11146 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11147
11148 backend smtp
11149 mode tcp
11150 balance roundrobin
11151 stick match src table pop
11152 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11153 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11154
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011155 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011156
11157
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011158stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011159 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011160 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011161 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011163 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011164
11165 Arguments :
11166 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11167 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11168 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11169 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11170
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011171 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11172 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11173 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11174 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11175
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011176 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11177 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11178 instance.
11179
11180 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11181 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11182 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11183 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11184 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11185 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011186 to 32 characters.
11187
11188 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11189 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11190 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011191 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011192 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11193 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011194
11195 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011196 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11197 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011198 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11199 increase.
11200
11201 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011202 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11203 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11204 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011205
11206 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011207 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011208 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11209 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011210 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011211 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11212 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11213 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11214 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11215 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11216 parameter (see below).
11217
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011218 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11219 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11220 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11221 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11222 soft restart.
11223
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011224 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11225 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11226 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11227 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011228 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011229 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011230 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11231 if not expiration delay is specified.
11232
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011233 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11234 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11235 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11236 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11237 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11238 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11239 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11240 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11241 token.
11242
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011243 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11244 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11245 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11246 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011247 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11248 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11249 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11250 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11251 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11252 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11253 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11254 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11255 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11256 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11257 types and their arguments.
11258
11259 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11260 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11261 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11262 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11263
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011264 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11265 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11266 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11267 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11268 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11269 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11270 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11271 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11272 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11273 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011274 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11275 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11276 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11277 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011278
11279 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11280 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11281 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11282 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11283 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11284 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11285 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11286 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11287 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11288 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11289 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11290 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011291 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11292 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11293 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11294 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011295
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011296 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11297 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11298 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011299 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011300
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011301 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11302 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11303 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011304 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011305 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011306 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011307
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011308 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11309 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11310 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11311 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11312
11313 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11314 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11315 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11316 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11317 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11318 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11319
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011320 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11321 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11322 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11323 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11324 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11325 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11326 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11327 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11328 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11329 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011330 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11331 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11332 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011333
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011334 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11335 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11336 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11337 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11338
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011339 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11340 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11341 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11342 they were received.
11343
11344 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11345 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11346 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11347 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11348 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11349
11350 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11351 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11352 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11353 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11354 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11355
11356 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11357 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11358 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11359
11360 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11361 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11362 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11363 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11364 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11365
11366 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11367 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11368 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11369 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11370 the client side.
11371
11372 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11373 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11374 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11375 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11376 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11377 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11378 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11379
11380 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11381 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11382 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11383 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11384 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11385 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011386 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011387
11388 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11389 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11390 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11391 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11392 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11393 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11394
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011395 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11396 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11397 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11398 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11399 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11400
11401 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11402 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11403 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11404 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11405 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11406 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11407
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011408 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011409 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011410 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11411 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11412
11413 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11414 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11415 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11416 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11417 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11418 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11419 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11420 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11421 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11422 recommended for better fairness.
11423
11424 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011425 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011426 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11427 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11428
11429 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11430 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11431 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11432 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11433 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11434 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11435 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11436 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11437 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11438 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011439
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011440 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11441 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011442 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11443 reference it.
11444
11445 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11446 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011447 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11448 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11449 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011450
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011451 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11452 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11453 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11454 something that can be ignored.
11455
11456 Example:
11457 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11458 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11459 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11460 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11461
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011462 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011463 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011464
11465
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011466stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011467 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11469 no | no | yes | yes
11470
11471 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011472 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011473 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011474 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011475 server is selected.
11476
11477 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11478 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11479 the "stick-table" statement.
11480
11481 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11482 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11483 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11484 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11485
11486 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11487 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11488 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11489 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11490 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11491 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011492 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011493 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11494 rules.
11495
11496 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11497 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11498 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11499 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11500 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11501 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11502 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11503
11504 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11505 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11506 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11507 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11508
11509 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11510 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11511 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11512 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11513 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11514 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011515 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11516 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11517 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11518 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11519 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11520 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11521 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11522 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11523 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011524
11525 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11526
11527 Example :
11528 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11529 backend https
11530 mode tcp
11531 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011532 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011533 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011534
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011535 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11536 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11537
11538 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11539 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11540 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11541
11542 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11543 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011544
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011545 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11546 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11547 # at offset 44.
11548
11549 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11550 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11551
11552 # Learn on response if server hello.
11553 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011554
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011555 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11556 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11557
11558 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11559 extraction.
11560
11561
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011562tcp-check comment <string>
11563 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11564 it fails.
11565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11566 yes | no | yes | yes
11567
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011568 Arguments :
11569 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11570 rule fails.
11571
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011572 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11573 user-friendly error reporting.
11574
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011575 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11576 "tcp-check expect".
11577
11578
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011579tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11580 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011581 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011582 Opens a new connection
11583 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011584 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011585
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011586 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011587 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11588
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011589 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011590 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011591
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011592 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011593 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11594 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011595 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011596
11597 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011598
11599 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11600
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011601 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11602
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011603 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11604
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011605 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11606
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011607 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11608 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11609 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11610 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11611
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011612 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11613 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11614 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11615 haproxy -vv.
11616
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011617 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011618
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011619 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11620 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11621 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11622
11623 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11624 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11625 of the sequence.
11626
11627 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11628 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11629 do.
11630
11631 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11632 unset-var or comment rules.
11633
11634 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011635 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11636 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11637 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11638 option tcp-check
11639 tcp-check connect
11640 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11641 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11642 tcp-check send \r\n
11643 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11644 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11645 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11646 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11647 tcp-check send \r\n
11648 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11649 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11650
11651 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11652 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011653 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011654 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11655 tcp-check connect port 143
11656 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11657 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11658
11659 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11660
11661
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011662tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011663 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011664 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011665 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011666 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011667 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011668 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011669
11670 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011671 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11672
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011673 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11674 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11675 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11676 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11677 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11678 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11679 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11680 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11681 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11682 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11683
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011684 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011685 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11686 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011687 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11688 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11689 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11690
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011691 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11692 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11693 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011694 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11695 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011696 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11697 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011698 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11699 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011700 By default "L7OK" is used.
11701
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011702 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11703 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011704 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11705 supported :
11706 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11707 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011708 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11709 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11710 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11711 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11712 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011713
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011714 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011715 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011716 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11717 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11718 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11719 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011720 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11721
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011722 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11723 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11724 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11725 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11726
11727 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11728 informational message reported in logs if an error
11729 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11730 log-format string.
11731
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011732 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11733 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11734 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11735 followed by some converters.
11736
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011737 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11738 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11739 with the usual backslash ('\').
11740 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011741 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011742 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11743 used upper or lower case.
11744
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011745 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11746
11747 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11748 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11749 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11750 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11751 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11752 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11753 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11754 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11755
11756 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11757 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11758 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11759 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11760 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11761 expression.
11762
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011763 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11764 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11765 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11766 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11767 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11768 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11769
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011770 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11771 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11772 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11773 this exact hexadecimal string.
11774 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11775
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011776 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11777 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11778 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11779 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11780 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11781 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11782 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11783 size.
11784
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011785 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11786 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11787 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11788 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11789 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11790 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11791 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11792 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11793 in a binary string before matching the response's
11794 buffer.
11795
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011796 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011797 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011798 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11799 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11800 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11801 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11802 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11803 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11804 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11805 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11806 the null character.
11807
11808 Examples :
11809 # perform a POP check
11810 option tcp-check
11811 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11812
11813 # perform an IMAP check
11814 option tcp-check
11815 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11816
11817 # look for the redis master server
11818 option tcp-check
11819 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011820 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011821 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11822 tcp-check expect string role:master
11823 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11824 tcp-check expect string +OK
11825
11826
11827 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011828 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011829
11830
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011831tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11832tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11833 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11834 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011835 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011836 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011837
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011838 Arguments :
11839 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11840
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011841 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11842 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011843
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011844 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11845 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011846
11847 Examples :
11848 # look for the redis master server
11849 option tcp-check
11850 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11851 tcp-check expect string role:master
11852
11853 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011854 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011855
11856
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011857tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11858tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11859 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11860 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011861 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011862 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011863
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011864 Arguments :
11865 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011866
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011867 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11868 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011869
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011870 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11871 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11872 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011873
11874 Examples :
11875 # redis check in binary
11876 option tcp-check
11877 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11878 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11879
11880
11881 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011882 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011883
11884
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011885tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011886 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011888 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011889
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011890 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011891 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11892 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11893 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11894 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11895 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11896 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11897 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11898 and '-'.
11899
11900 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11901
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011902 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011903 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11904
11905
11906tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011907 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011908 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011909 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011910
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011911 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011912 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11913 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11914 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11915 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11916 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11917 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11918 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11919 and '-'.
11920
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011921 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011922 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11923
11924
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011925tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11926 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11928 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011929 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011930 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11931 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011932
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011933 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011934
11935 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11936 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011937 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11938 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11939 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11940 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11941 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11942 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011943
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011944 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11945 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11946 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11947 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011948
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011949 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011950 - accept :
11951 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11952 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11953 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011954
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011955 - reject :
11956 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11957 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11958 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11959 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11960 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11961 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11962 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11963 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11964 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11965 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11966 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011967 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011968
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011969 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11970 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11971 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11972 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11973 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11974 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11975 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11976 hosts.
11977
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011978 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11979 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11980 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11981 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11982 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11983 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11984 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11985 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11986
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011987 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11988 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11989 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11990 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11991 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11992 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11993 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11994 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11995 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011996 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11997 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011998
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011999 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012000 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012001 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12002 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12003 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012004 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012005 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012006 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12007 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12008 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12009 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12010 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12011 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12012 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012013
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012014 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012015 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012016 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012017 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012018 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12019 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12020 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012021
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012022 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12023 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12024 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12025 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012026
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012027 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12028 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12029 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12030 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12031 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012032 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12033 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12034 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12035 layer7 information is extracted.
12036
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012037 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12038 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12039 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12040 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12041 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012042
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012043 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12044 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12045 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12046 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12047 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12048 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12049 no GPC stored at this index.
12050 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12051 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12052 data_types).
12053
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012054 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12055 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12056 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12057 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12058
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012059 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12060 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12061 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12062 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12063
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012064 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12065 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12066 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12067 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12068 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12069 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12070 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12071 no GPT stored at this index.
12072 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12073 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12074
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012075 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12076 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12077 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12078 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12079 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012080
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012081 - set-mark <mark>:
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +010012082 Is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the client
12083 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value
12084 is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by
12085 the routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace.
12086 It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
12087 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
12088 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works
12089 on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +010012090 on FreeBSD and OpenBSD.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012091
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012092 - set-src <expr> :
12093 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12094 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12095 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012096 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012097
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012098 Arguments:
12099 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12100 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012101
12102 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012103 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12104
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012105 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12106 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012107
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012108 - set-src-port <expr> :
12109 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12110 expression.
12111
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012112 Arguments:
12113 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12114 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012115
12116 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012117 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12118
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012119 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12120 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12121 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012122
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012123 - set-dst <expr> :
12124 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12125 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12126 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12127 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12128 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12129
12130 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12131 followed by some converters.
12132
12133 Example:
12134
12135 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12136 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12137
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012138 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12139 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12140
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012141 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12142 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12143 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12144 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12145
12146
12147 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12148 followed by some converters.
12149
12150 Example:
12151
12152 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12153
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012154 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12155 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12156 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12157
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012158 - set-tos <tos>:
12159 Is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12160 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
12161 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed
12162 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only
12163 the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
12164 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border
12165 routers based on some information from the request.
12166
12167 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
12168
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012169 - "silent-drop" :
12170 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012171 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012172 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12173 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12174 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12175 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12176 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012177 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12178 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012179 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12180 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012181 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012182 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12183 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12184 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12185 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12186
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012187 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12188 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12189 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012190
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012191 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12192 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12193 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012194
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012195 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012196 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012197 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012198
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012199 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12200 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12201 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012202
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012203 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012204 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12205 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012206
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012207 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12208
12209 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12210
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012211 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12212
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012213 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012214
12215
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012216tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12217 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012219 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012220 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012221 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12222 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012223
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012224 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012225
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012226 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012227 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12228 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012229 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12230 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012231
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012232 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12233 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12234 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12235 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012236 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012237 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012238 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12239 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12240 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12241 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012242 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012243 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012244
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012245 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12246 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12247 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12248 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012249
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012250 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012251 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012252 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012253 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12254 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012255 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012256 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012257 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012258 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012259 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012260 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012261 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012262 - set-dst <expr>
12263 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012264 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012265 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012266 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012267 - set-tos <tos>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012268 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012269 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012270 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012271 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012272 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012273 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012275 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12276 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012277 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12278 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012279
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012280 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12281 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12282 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12283 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12284 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12285 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012287 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012288 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12289 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012290
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012291 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12292 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12293 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12294 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12295 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12296 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12297
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012298 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012299 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12300 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12301 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12302 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12303 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12304 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12305 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12306 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12307 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12308 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012309
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012310 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012311 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12312 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12313 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012314
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012315 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12316 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12317
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012318 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current session. More
12319 information on how to use it at "http-request set-log-level".
12320
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012321 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to the
12322 client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-mark".
12323
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012324 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current session. More
12325 information on how to use it at "http-request set-nice".
12326
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012327 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
12328 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-tos".
12329
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012330 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012331 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12332 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012333
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012334 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12335 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012336 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012337 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12338 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012339 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012340 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012341 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012342 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12343 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012344 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012345 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12346 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012347
12348 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12349 followed by some converters.
12350
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012351 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012352 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12353 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12354 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12355 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12356 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12357 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012358 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012359 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12360 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12361
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012362 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12363
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012364 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12365 <var-name>.
12366
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012367 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12368 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12369 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12370 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12371 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12372
12373 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12374 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12375 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12376 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12377 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12378 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12379 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12380 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12381 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12382 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12383 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12384
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012385 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12386 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12387 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12388 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12389 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12390
12391 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12392
12393 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12394
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012395 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12396 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12397 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12398 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12399 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12400 evaluated.
12401
12402 Example:
12403 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12404
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012405 Example:
12406
12407 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012408 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012409
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012410 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012411 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012412 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012413 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12414 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012415 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012416 tcp-request content reject
12417
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012418 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12419 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12420 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12421 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12422 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12423 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12424 ...
12425 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12426
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012427 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012428 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12429 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12430 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012431 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012432
12433 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12434 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12435 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012436 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012437 tcp-request content reject
12438
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012439 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012440 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012441 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012442 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012443 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12444 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012445
12446 Example:
12447 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12448 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012449 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012450
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012451 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012452 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012453
12454 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012455 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012456 # protecting all our sites
12457 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012458 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12459 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012460 ...
12461 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12462
12463 backend http_dynamic
12464 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012465 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012466 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012467 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012468 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012469 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012470 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012472 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012473
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012474 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12475 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012476
12477
12478tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12479 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012481 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012482 Arguments :
12483 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12484 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12485 as explained at the top of this document.
12486
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012487 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012488 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12489 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12490 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12491 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12492
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012493 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12494 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12495 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12496 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12497
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012498 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012499 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012500 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012501 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012502 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012503 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12504 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12505 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012506
12507 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12508 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12509 it pass through unaffected.
12510
12511 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12512 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12513 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012514 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012515 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12516 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012517 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12518 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12519 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012520
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012521 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012522 "timeout client".
12523
12524
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012525tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12526 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12528 no | no | yes | yes
12529 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012530 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12531 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012532
12533 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12534
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012535 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012536 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12537 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012538 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12539 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012540
12541 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12542
12543 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12544 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12545 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12546 inserted.
12547
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012548 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012549 - accept :
12550 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12551 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12552 the rules evaluation.
12553
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012554 - close :
12555 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12556 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12557 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12558 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12559 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12560 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012561 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012562 protocols.
12563
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012564 - reject :
12565 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12566 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012567 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012568
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012569 - set-log-level <level>
12570 The "set-log-level" is used to set the log level of the current
12571 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12572 set-log-level".
12573
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012574 - set-mark <mark>
12575 The "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK in all packets sent to
12576 the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12577 set-mark".
12578
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012579 - set-nice <nice>
12580 The "set-nice" is used to set the "nice" factor of the current
12581 session. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12582 set-nice".
12583
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012584 - set-tos <tos>
12585 The "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets
12586 sent to the client. More information on how to use it at "http-response
12587 set-tos".
12588
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012589 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreaue7267122021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012590 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012591
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012592 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12593 Unsets a variable.
12594
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012595 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>):
12596 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
12597 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
12598 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12599 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12600 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12601 no GPC stored at this index.
12602 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types
12603 (and not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate'
12604 data_types).
12605
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012606 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12607 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12608 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12609 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12610
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012611 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12612 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12613 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12614 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12615
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012616 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12617 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the
12618 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the
12619 value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
12620 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
12621 evaluation continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id>
12622 is an integer between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is
12623 no GPT stored at this index.
12624 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
12625 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
12626
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012627 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12628 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12629 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12630 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12631 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012632
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012633 - "silent-drop" :
12634 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012635 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012636 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12637 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12638 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12639 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12640 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012641 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12642 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012643 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12644 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012645 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012646 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12647 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12648 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12649 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12650
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012651 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12652 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12653
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012654 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12655 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12656 for changing the default action to a reject.
12657
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012658 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12659 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12660 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12661 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012662 period.
12663
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012664 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12665 declared inline.
12666
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012667 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12668 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012669 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012670 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12671 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012672 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012673 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012674 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012675 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12676 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012677 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012678 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12679 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012680
12681 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12682 followed by some converters.
12683
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012684 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12685 <var-name>.
12686
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012687 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12688 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12689 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12690 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12691 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12692
12693 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12694
12695 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12696
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012697 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12698
12699 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12700
12701
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012702tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12703 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12705 no | yes | yes | no
12706 Arguments :
12707 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12708 below.
12709
12710 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12711
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012712 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012713 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12714 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12715 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12716 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12717 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12718 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12719 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012720 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012721 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12722 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12723 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12724 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12725 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12726 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12727 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12728 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12729 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12730 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12731 instead.
12732
12733 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12734 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12735 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12736 rules which may be inserted.
12737
12738 Several types of actions are supported :
12739 - accept : the request is accepted
12740 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12741 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012742 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012743 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012744 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012745 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012746 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012747 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet14aec6e2021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012748 - set-dst <expr>
12749 - set-dst-port <expr>
12750 - set-src <expr>
12751 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012752 - set-tos <tos>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012753 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012754 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012755 - silent-drop
12756
12757 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12758 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12759 sections for a complete description.
12760
12761 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12762 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12763 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12764
12765 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12766 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12767 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12768 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12769 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12770
12771 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12772 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12773
12774 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12775 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12776 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12777
12778 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12779 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12780 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12781
12782 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12783 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12784 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12785
12786 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12787 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12788 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12789
12790 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12791
12792 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12793
12794
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012795tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12796 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12798 no | no | yes | yes
12799 Arguments :
12800 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12801 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12802 as explained at the top of this document.
12803
12804 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12805
12806
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012807timeout check <timeout>
12808 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12809 established.
12810
12811 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12812 yes | no | yes | yes
12813 Arguments:
12814 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12815 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12816 as explained at the top of this document.
12817
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012818 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012819 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012820 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012821 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012822 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12823 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12824 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012825
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012826 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012827 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12828
12829 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12830 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012831 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012832
12833 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12834 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12835 forget about it.
12836
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012837 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12838 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012839
12840
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012841timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012842 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12844 yes | yes | yes | no
12845 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012846 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012847 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12848 as explained at the top of this document.
12849
12850 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12851 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12852 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012853 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12854 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12855 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12856 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012857 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12858 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12859 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012860 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012861 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012862 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12863 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012864 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12865 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012866
12867 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12868 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12869 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12870 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012871 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012872 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12873
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012874 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012875
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012876 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012878
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012879timeout client-fin <timeout>
12880 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12882 yes | yes | yes | no
12883 Arguments :
12884 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12885 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12886 as explained at the top of this document.
12887
12888 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12889 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12890 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12891 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12892 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12893 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12894 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012895 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12896 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12897 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012898
12899 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12900 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12901 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12902
12903 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12904
12905
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012906timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012907 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12909 yes | no | yes | yes
12910 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012911 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012912 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12913 as explained at the top of this document.
12914
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012915 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012916 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012917 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012918 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012919 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12920 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012921
12922 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12923 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12924 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12925 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012926 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012927 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12928
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012929 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012930
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012931
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012932timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12933 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12935 yes | yes | yes | yes
12936 Arguments :
12937 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12938 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12939 as explained at the top of this document.
12940
12941 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12942 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12943 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12944 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12945 once the request has started to present itself.
12946
12947 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12948 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12949 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12950 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12951 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12952
12953 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12954 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12955 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12956 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12957
12958 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12959 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012960 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012961 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12962 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012963 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012964
12965 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12966 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12967 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12968 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12969
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012970 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12971 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012972 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12973
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012974 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12975
12976
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012977timeout http-request <timeout>
12978 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012980 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012981 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012982 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012983 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12984 as explained at the top of this document.
12985
12986 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12987 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12988 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12989 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12990 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12991 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12992 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012993 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12994 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12995 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12996 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012997 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012998 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12999 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013000
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013001 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13002 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13003 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13004 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13005 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013006 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013007
13008 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13009 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013010 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013011 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13012 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13013
13014 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013015 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13016 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13017 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013018
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013019 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013020 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013021
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013022
13023timeout queue <timeout>
13024 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13026 yes | no | yes | yes
13027 Arguments :
13028 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13029 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13030 as explained at the top of this document.
13031
13032 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13033 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13034 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13035 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13036 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13037
13038 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13039 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13040 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13041 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13042
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013043 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013044
13045
13046timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013047 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13049 yes | no | yes | yes
13050 Arguments :
13051 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13052 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13053 as explained at the top of this document.
13054
13055 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13056 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13057 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13058 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13059 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13060 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13061 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13062
13063 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13064 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13065 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13066 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13067 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013068 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013069 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013070 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13071 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013072 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13073 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013074
13075 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13076 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13077 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13078 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013079 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013080 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13081
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013082 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013083
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013084
13085timeout server-fin <timeout>
13086 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13088 yes | no | yes | yes
13089 Arguments :
13090 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13091 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13092 as explained at the top of this document.
13093
13094 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13095 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13096 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13097 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13098 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13099 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13100 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13101 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13102 situations, it should not be needed.
13103
13104 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13105 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13106 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13107
13108 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13109
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013110
13111timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013112 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13114 yes | yes | yes | yes
13115 Arguments :
13116 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13117 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13118 as explained at the top of this document.
13119
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013120 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13121 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13122 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013123
13124 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13125 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13126 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13127 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013128 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013129
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013130 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013131
13132
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013133timeout tunnel <timeout>
13134 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13136 yes | no | yes | yes
13137 Arguments :
13138 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13139 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13140 as explained at the top of this document.
13141
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013142 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013143 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13144 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13145 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013146 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13147 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013148 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13149 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13150 specified.
13151
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013152 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13153 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13154 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13155 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13156 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13157 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13158 state.
13159
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013160 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13161 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13162 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13163 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013164 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013165
13166 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13167 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13168 forget about it.
13169
13170 Example :
13171 defaults http
13172 option http-server-close
13173 timeout connect 5s
13174 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013175 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013176 timeout server 30s
13177 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13178
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013179 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013180
13181
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013182transparent (deprecated)
13183 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013185 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013186 Arguments : none
13187
13188 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13189 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13190 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13191 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13192 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13193 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13194 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13195 appropriate server.
13196
13197 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13198
13199 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13200 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13201
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013202 See also: "option transparent"
13203
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013204unique-id-format <string>
13205 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13207 yes | yes | yes | no
13208 Arguments :
13209 <string> is a log-format string.
13210
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013211 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13212 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13213 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13214 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013215
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013216 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013217 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013218 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13219 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13220 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13221 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13222 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13223 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013224
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013225 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13226 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013227
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013228 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013229
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013230 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013231
13232 will generate:
13233
13234 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13235
13236 See also: "unique-id-header"
13237
13238unique-id-header <name>
13239 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13241 yes | yes | yes | no
13242 Arguments :
13243 <name> is the name of the header.
13244
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013245 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13246 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013247
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013248 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013249
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013250 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013251 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13252
13253 will generate:
13254
13255 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13256
13257 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013258
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013259use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013260 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13262 no | yes | yes | no
13263 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013264 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13265 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013266
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013267 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13268 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013269
13270 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13271 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13272 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013273 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013274 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013275 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13276 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013277
13278 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13279 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13280 assign the backend.
13281
13282 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13283 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13284 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13285 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13286 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13287 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13288
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013289 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013290 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013291 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13292 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13293 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13294
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013295 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13296 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13297 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13298 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13299 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13300 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13301 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13302 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13303 cannot be forced from the request.
13304
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013305 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013306 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13307 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13308
13309 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13310 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013311
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013312use-fcgi-app <name>
13313 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13315 no | no | yes | yes
13316 Arguments :
13317 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13318
13319 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013320
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013321use-server <server> if <condition>
13322use-server <server> unless <condition>
13323 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13325 no | no | yes | yes
13326 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013327 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13328 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013329
13330 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13331
13332 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13333 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13334 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13335
13336 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13337 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13338 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13339 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13340 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13341 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13342 matches will assign the server.
13343
13344 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13345 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13346 with the next rules until one matches.
13347
13348 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13349 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13350 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13351 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13352
13353 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13354 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13355 stripped.
13356
13357 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13358 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013359 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013360 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013361 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013362
13363 Example :
13364 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013365 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013366 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013367 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013368 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013369 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013370 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013371 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13372 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13373
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013374 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13375 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13376 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13377 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013378 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013379 and we fall back to load balancing.
13380
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013381 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013382
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013383
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133845. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013385--------------------------
13386
13387The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13388depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13389settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13390written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13391described in this section.
13392
13393
133945.1. Bind options
13395-----------------
13396
13397The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13398as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13399no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13400parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13401while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13402provided immediately after the setting name.
13403
13404The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13405
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013406accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13407 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13408 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13409 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13410 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13411 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13412 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13413 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13414 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13415 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013416 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13417 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13418 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013419
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013420accept-proxy
13421 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013422 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13423 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013424 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13425 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13426 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13427 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013428 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013429 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13430 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013431 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13432 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013433
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013434allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013435 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013436 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013437 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013438 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13439 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013440
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013441alpn <protocols>
13442 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13443 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13444 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013445 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013446 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013447 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13448 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13449 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13450 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13451 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13452 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13453 preference, like below :
13454
13455 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013456
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013457backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013458 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013459 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13460
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013461curves <curves>
13462 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13463 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13464 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13465 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13466 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13467 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13468
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013469ecdhe <named curve>
13470 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013471 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13472 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013473
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013474ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013475 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13476 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13477 client's certificate.
13478
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013479ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13480 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13481 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13482 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13483 error is ignored.
13484
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013485ca-sign-file <cafile>
13486 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13487 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13488 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13489 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13490 'generate-certificates' for details.
13491
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013492ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013493 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13494 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13495 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13496 'generate-certificates' for details.
13497
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013498ca-verify-file <cafile>
13499 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13500 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13501 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13502 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13503 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13504
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013505ciphers <ciphers>
13506 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13507 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013508 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013509 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013510 information and recommendations see e.g.
13511 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13512 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13513 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13514
13515ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13516 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13517 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13518 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13519 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013520 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13521 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013522
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013523crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013524 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13525 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013526 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13527 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013528
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013529crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013530 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13531 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13532 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13533 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13534 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013535 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13536 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013537
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013538 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13539 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13540
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013541 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13542 are loaded.
13543
13544 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013545 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13546 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13547 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13548 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13549 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13550 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13551 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013552 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013553
13554 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13555 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13556 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13557 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013558 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13559 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013560
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013561 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013562
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013563 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013564 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013565 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13566 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013567 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13568 clients).
13569
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013570 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013571 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13572 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13573 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13574 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13575 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13576 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13577 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13578 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13579 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13580 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13581 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13582 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13583
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013584 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013585 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13586 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13587 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13588 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13589
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013590 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13591 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13592 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13593 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013594
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013595 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13596 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13597 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013598
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013599crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013600 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013601 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013602 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013603 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013604
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013605crt-list <file>
13606 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013607 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13608 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013609
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013610 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13611
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013612 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13613 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13614 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13615 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13616 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013617
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013618 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013619 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13620 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13621 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13622 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13623 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013624 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13625 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13626 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013627
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013628 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13629 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13630 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013631
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013632 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13633
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013634 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013635 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013636 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13637 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13638 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13639 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13640 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13641 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013642
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013643 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013644 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013645 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013646 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013647 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013648 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013649
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013650defer-accept
13651 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13652 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13653 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013654 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013655 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13656 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13657 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13658 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13659 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13660 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13661 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13662
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013663expose-fd listeners
13664 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13665 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013666 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13667 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013668 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013669
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013670force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013671 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013672 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013673 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013674 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013675
13676force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013677 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013678 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013679 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013680
13681force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013682 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013683 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013684 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013685
13686force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013687 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013688 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013689 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013690
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013691force-tlsv13
13692 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13693 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013694 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013695
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013696generate-certificates
13697 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13698 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13699 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13700 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13701 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13702 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13703 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13704 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13705 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13706 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13707 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13708
13709 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13710 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013711 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013712 certificate is used many times.
13713
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013714gid <gid>
13715 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13716 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13717 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13718 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13719 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13720
13721group <group>
13722 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13723 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13724 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13725 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13726 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13727
13728id <id>
13729 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13730 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13731 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13732 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13733
13734interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013735 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13736 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13737 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13738 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13739 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13740 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013741 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13742 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13743 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13744 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13745 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13746 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013747
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013748level <level>
13749 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13750 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13751 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013752 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013753 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13754 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13755 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013756 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013757 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013758 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013759 all counters).
13760
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013761severity-output <format>
13762 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13763 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13764 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13765 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13766 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13767 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13768 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13769 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13770 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13771 rfc5424 convention.
13772
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013773maxconn <maxconn>
13774 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13775 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13776 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13777 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13778 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13779 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13780 eat all memory.
13781
13782mode <mode>
13783 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13784 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13785 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13786 UNIX sockets.
13787
13788mss <maxseg>
13789 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13790 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13791 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13792 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13793 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13794 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13795 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13796 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13797 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13798 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13799 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13800
13801name <name>
13802 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13803 page.
13804
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013805namespace <name>
13806 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13807 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13808 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13809 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13810
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013811nice <nice>
13812 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13813 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13814 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13815 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13816 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13817 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13818 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13819 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13820 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13821 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13822 one for an RDP socket.
13823
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013824no-ca-names
13825 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13826 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013827 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013828
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013829no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013830 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013831 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013832 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013833 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013834 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13835 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013836
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013837no-tls-tickets
13838 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13839 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13840 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013841 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13842 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013843 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13844 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13845 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013846
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013847no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013849 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013850 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013851 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013852 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13853 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013854
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013855no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013857 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013858 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013859 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013860 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13861 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013862
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013863no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013864 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013865 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013866 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013867 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013868 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13869 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013870
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013871no-tlsv13
13872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13873 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13874 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13875 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013876 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13877 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013878
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013879npn <protocols>
13880 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13881 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13882 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013883 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013884 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013885 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13886 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13887 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13888 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13889 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013890
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013891prefer-client-ciphers
13892 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13893 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13894 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013895 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13896 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13897 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013898
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013899process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020013900 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
13901 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
13902 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
13903 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
13904 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
13905 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013906
13907 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13908
13909 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020013910 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
13911 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
13912 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
13913 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
13914 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013915
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013916proto <name>
13917 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13918 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13919 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013920 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13921 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13922
13923 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13924 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13925 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13926 also reported (flag=HTX).
13927
13928 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13929 a bind line :
13930
13931 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13932 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13933 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13934
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013935 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013936 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013937 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013938 h2" on the bind line.
13939
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013940ssl
13941 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013942 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013943 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13944 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013945 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13946 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013947
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013948ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13949 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013950 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13951 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13952 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013953 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13954
13955ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013956 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13957 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13958 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13959 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013960
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013961strict-sni
13962 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13963 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13964 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13965 See the "crt" option for more information.
13966
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013967tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013968 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013969 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013970 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013971 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013972 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13973 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13974 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13975 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13976 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13977 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13978 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13979
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013980tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013981 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013982 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13983 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13984 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13985 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13986 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13987 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13988 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013989 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13990 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13991 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013992
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013993tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13994 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013995 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13996 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13997 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13998 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13999 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14000 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14001 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14002 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14003 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14004 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014005 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14006 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14007
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014008transparent
14009 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14010 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14011 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14012 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14013 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14014 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14015 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14016 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14017 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14018 so check for support with your vendor.
14019
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014020v4v6
14021 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14022 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14023 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14024 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014025 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014026
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014027v6only
14028 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14029 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14030 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014031 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14032 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014033
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014034uid <uid>
14035 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14036 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14037 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14038 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14039 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14040
14041user <user>
14042 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14043 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14044 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14045 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14046 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14047
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014048verify [none|optional|required]
14049 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14050 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14051 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14052 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14053 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014054 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14055 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14056 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14057 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014058
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140595.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014060------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014061
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014062The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14063which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14064arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14065settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14066after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14067Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14068address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014070 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014071 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014072
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014073Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14074keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14075
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014076The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014077
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014078addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014079 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014080 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14081 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14082 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14083 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14084 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014085
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014086agent-check
14087 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014088 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014089 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14090 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14091 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014092
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014093 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014094 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014095 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014096 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14097 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014098
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014099 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14100 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14101 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14102 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14103 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014104
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014105 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014106 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014107
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014108 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14109 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14110 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014111
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014112 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14113 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14114 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014115
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014116 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014117 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14118 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14119 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14120 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014121 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014122 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014123
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014124 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14125 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014126
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014127 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14128 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14129 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14130 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14131 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14132 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14133 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14134 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14135 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014136
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014137 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14138 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014139 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14140 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14141 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014142 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014143
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014144 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014145 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014146
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014147agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014148 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014149 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14150 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14151 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14152 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14153
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014154agent-inter <delay>
14155 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14156 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14157
14158 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14159 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14160 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14161 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14162 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14163 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14164 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14165 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14166 of backends use the same servers.
14167
14168 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14169
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014170agent-addr <addr>
14171 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14172
14173 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014174 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014175 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14176 hostname, it will be resolved.
14177
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014178agent-port <port>
14179 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14180
14181 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14182
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014183allow-0rtt
14184 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014185 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14186 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014187
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014188alpn <protocols>
14189 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14190 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14191 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014192 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014193 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14194 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14195 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14196 now obsolete NPN extension.
14197 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14198 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14199
14200 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14201
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014202backup
14203 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14204 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14205 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14206 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014207 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14208 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014209
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014210ca-file <cafile>
14211 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14212 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14213 server's certificate.
14214
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014215check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014216 This option enables health checks on a server:
14217 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14218 considered available.
14219 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14220 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14221 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14222 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14223 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14224 set.
14225 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14226 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14227 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14228 exchanges succeed.
14229
14230 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14231 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14232 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14233 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14234 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014235 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014236 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14237
14238 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14239 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14240
14241 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14242 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14243
14244 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14245 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14246 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14247 available.
14248
14249 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14250 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14251 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14252
14253 Example:
14254 # simple tcp check
14255 backend foo
14256 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14257 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14258 backend foo
14259 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14260 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14261 backend foo
14262 option tcp-check
14263 tcp-check connect
14264 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014265
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014266check-send-proxy
14267 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14268 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14269 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14270 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14271 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14272 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14273 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14274
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014275check-alpn <protocols>
14276 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14277 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14278 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14279
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014280check-proto <name>
14281 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14282 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14283 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014284 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14285 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14286
14287 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14288 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14289 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14290 also reported (flag=HTX).
14291
14292 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14293 directive on a server line:
14294
14295 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14296 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14297 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14298 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14299
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014300 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014301 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14302 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14303
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014304check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014305 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014306 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14307 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014308
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014309check-ssl
14310 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14311 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14312 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14313 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014314 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014315 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14316 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014317 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014318 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14319 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014320
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014321check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014322 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014323 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14324 for normal traffic.
14325
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014326ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014327 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14328 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14329 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014330 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14331 information and recommendations see e.g.
14332 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14333 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14334 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014335
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014336ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14337 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14338 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14339 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14340 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014341 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14342 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14343 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014345cookie <value>
14346 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14347 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14348 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14349 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14350 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14351 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14352 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14353
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014354crl-file <crlfile>
14355 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14356 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14357 to verify server's certificate.
14358
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014359crt <cert>
14360 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14361 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14362 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14363 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14364 certificate request.
14365
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014366 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14367 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14368 option is set accordingly).
14369
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014370disabled
14371 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14372 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14373 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14374 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14375 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014376 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014377
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014378enabled
14379 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14380 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14381 default value.
14382 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14383 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014384
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014385error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014386 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14387 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14388 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014390 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014391
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014392fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014393 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14394 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14395 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14396
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014397force-sslv3
14398 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14399 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014400 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014401 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014402
14403force-tlsv10
14404 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014405 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014406 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014407
14408force-tlsv11
14409 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014410 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014411 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014412
14413force-tlsv12
14414 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014415 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014416 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014417
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014418force-tlsv13
14419 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14420 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014421 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014423id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014424 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14425 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14426 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014427
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014428init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14429 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14430 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014431 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014432 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14433 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14434 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14435 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14436 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14437 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14438 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14439 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14440 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014441 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014442 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14443 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14444 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14445 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14446 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14447 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014448 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014449
14450 Example:
14451 defaults
14452 # never fail on address resolution
14453 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014455inter <delay>
14456fastinter <delay>
14457downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014458 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14459 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14460 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14461 between checks depending on the server state :
14462
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014463 Server state | Interval used
14464 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14465 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14466 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14467 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14468 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14469 or yet unchecked. |
14470 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14471 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14472 | "inter" otherwise.
14473 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014474
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014475 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14476 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14477 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14478 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014479 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14480 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14481 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14482 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14483 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014484
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014485log-proto <logproto>
14486 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14487 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14488 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14489 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014491maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014492 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14493 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014494 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14495 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014496 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14497 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14498 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14499 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14500
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014501 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14502 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14503 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14504 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14505 than 50 concurrent requests.
14506
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014507maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014508 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14509 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14510 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14511 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014512 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14513 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14514 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14515 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14516 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14517 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14518 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014519
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014520max-reuse <count>
14521 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14522 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14523 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14524 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14525 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14526 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14527 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14528 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14529
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014530minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014531 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14532 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14533 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14534 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14535 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14536 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014537 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014538 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014539
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014540namespace <name>
14541 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14542 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14543 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14544 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14545
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014546no-agent-check
14547 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14548 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14549 default value.
14550 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14551 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14552
14553no-backup
14554 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14555 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14556 default value.
14557 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14558 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14559
14560no-check
14561 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14562 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14563 default value.
14564 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14565 "default-server" "check" setting.
14566
14567no-check-ssl
14568 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14569 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14570 default value.
14571 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14572 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14573
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014574no-send-proxy
14575 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14576 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14577 default value.
14578 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14579 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14580
14581no-send-proxy-v2
14582 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14583 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14584 default value.
14585 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14586 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14587
14588no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14589 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14590 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14591 default value.
14592 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14593 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14594
14595no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14596 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14597 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14598 default value.
14599 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14600 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14601
14602no-ssl
14603 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14604 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14605 default value.
14606 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14607 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14608
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014609 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14610 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14611 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14612
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014613no-ssl-reuse
14614 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14615 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14616 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14617 and for paranoid users.
14618
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014619no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014620 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14621 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014622 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014623
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014624 Supported in default-server: No
14625
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014626no-tls-tickets
14627 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14628 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14629 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014630 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14631 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014632 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14633 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14634 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014635 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014636
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014637no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014638 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014639 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14640 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014641 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14642 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014643 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014644
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014645 Supported in default-server: No
14646
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014647no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014648 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014649 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14650 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014651 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14652 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014653 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014654
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014655 Supported in default-server: No
14656
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014657no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014658 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014659 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14660 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014661 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14662 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014663 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014664
14665 Supported in default-server: No
14666
14667no-tlsv13
14668 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14669 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14670 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14671 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14672 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014673 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014674
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014675 Supported in default-server: No
14676
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014677no-verifyhost
14678 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14679 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14680 default value.
14681 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14682 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014683
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014684no-tfo
14685 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14686 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14687 default value.
14688 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14689 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14690
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014691non-stick
14692 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14693 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14694 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14695
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014696npn <protocols>
14697 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14698 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14699 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014700 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014701 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14702 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14703 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14704
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014705observe <mode>
14706 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14707 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14708 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14709 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14710 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14711 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014712 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014713
14714 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014716on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014717 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14718 Currently, four modes are available:
14719 - fastinter: force fastinter
14720 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14721 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14722 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14723 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14724
14725 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14726
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014727on-marked-down <action>
14728 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14729 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014730 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14731 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14732 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14733 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14734 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14735 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14736 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14737 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014738
14739 Actions are disabled by default
14740
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014741on-marked-up <action>
14742 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14743 Currently one action is available:
14744 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14745 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14746 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14747 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014748 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14749 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014750 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14751 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14752
14753 Actions are disabled by default
14754
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014755pool-low-conn <max>
14756 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14757 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14758 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14759 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14760 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14761 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14762 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14763 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14764 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14765 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014766 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14767 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14768 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14769 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014770
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014771pool-max-conn <max>
14772 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14773 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14774 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14775 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14776 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14777 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14778
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014779pool-purge-delay <delay>
14780 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014781 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014782 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014783
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014784port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014785 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014786 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14787 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14788 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14789 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14790 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014791
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014792proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014793 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14794 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14795 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014796 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14797 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14798
14799 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14800 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14801 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14802 also reported (flag=HTX).
14803
14804 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14805 a server line :
14806
14807 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14808 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14809 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14810 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14811
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014812 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014813 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014815redir <prefix>
14816 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14817 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14818 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14819 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14820 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14821 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14822 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14823 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014824 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014825 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014826 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14827 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14828 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14829 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14830
14831 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14832
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014833rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014834 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14835 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14836 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14837
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014838resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14839 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14840 server.
14841
14842 Available options:
14843
14844 * allow-dup-ip
14845 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14846 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14847 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14848 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14849 For such case, simply enable this option.
14850 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14851
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014852 * ignore-weight
14853 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14854 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14855 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14856
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014857 * prevent-dup-ip
14858 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14859 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14860 same fqdn.
14861 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14862
14863 Example:
14864 backend b_myapp
14865 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14866 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14867 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14868
14869 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14870 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14871 it
14872 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14873 different address
14874
14875 Default value: not set
14876
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014877resolve-prefer <family>
14878 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14879 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14880 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14881 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14882
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014883 Default value: ipv6
14884
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014885 Example:
14886
14887 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014888
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014889resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014890 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014891 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014892 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014893 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14894 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014895 configured network, another address is selected.
14896
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014897 Example:
14898
14899 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014900
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014901resolvers <id>
14902 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14903 hostname.
14904
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014905 Example:
14906
14907 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014908
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014909 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014910
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014911send-proxy
14912 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14913 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14914 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14915 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014916 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14917 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14918 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14919 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014920 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014921 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14922 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14923 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14924 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14925 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014926 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14927 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014928
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014929send-proxy-v2
14930 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14931 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14932 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14933 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014934 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14935 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14936 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14937 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014938
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014939proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014940 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14941 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14942
14943 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14944 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14945 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14946 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14947 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14948 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14949 connection is supported).
14950 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14951 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14952 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14953 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14954 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14955 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14956 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014957
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014958send-proxy-v2-ssl
14959 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14960 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14961 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14962 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14963 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14964 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14965 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014966 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14967 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014968
14969send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14970 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14971 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14972 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14973 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14974 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14975 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14976 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14977 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014978 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14979 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014980
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014981slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014982 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14983 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14984 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14985 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14986 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14987 parameters :
14988
14989 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14990 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14991
14992 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14993 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14994 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14995 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14996
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014997 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014998 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14999 seen as failed.
15000
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015001sni <expression>
15002 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15003 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15004 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
15005 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015006 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
15007 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015008 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015009 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15010 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015011
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015012source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015013source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015014source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015015 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15016 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15017 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15018 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15019
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015020 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15021 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15022 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15023 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15024 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15025 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15026 server.
15027
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015028 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15029 specifying the source address without port(s).
15030
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015031ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015032 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15033 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15034 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15035 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15036 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15037 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015038 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15039 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015040
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015041ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15042 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15043 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15044 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15045
15046ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15047 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15048 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15049 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15050
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015051ssl-reuse
15052 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15053 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15054 default value.
15055 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15056 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15057
15058stick
15059 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15060 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15061 default value.
15062 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15063 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015064
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015065socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015066 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015067 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15068 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15069
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015070tcp-ut <delay>
15071 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015072 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015073 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015074 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015075 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15076 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15077 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15078 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15079 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15080 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15081 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15082 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15083 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15084
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015085tfo
15086 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15087 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15088 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15089 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015090 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015091 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015093track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015094 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15095 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15096 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15097 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015098 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15099
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015100tls-tickets
15101 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15102 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15103 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015104 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15105 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15106 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015107 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015108 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015109
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015110verify [none|required]
15111 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015112 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015113 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15114 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015115 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015116 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15117 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15118 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15119 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15120 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15121 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15122 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15123 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015124
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015125verifyhost <hostname>
15126 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015127 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15128 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15129 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15130 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15131 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15132 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15133 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15134 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015135
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015136weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015137 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15138 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15139 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015140 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15141 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15142 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15143 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15144 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15145 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015146
15147
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151485.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15149-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015150
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015151HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15152using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015153configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015154This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15155can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15156workload.
15157This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15158resolution at run time.
15159Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15160carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15161
15162
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151635.3.1. Global overview
15164----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015165
15166As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15167different steps of the process life:
15168
15169 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15170 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15171 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15172
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015173 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15174 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015175
15176A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15177 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15178 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15179 resolution to know this new IP.
15180
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015181When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015182HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015183SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15184from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015185will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015186will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015187
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015188A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015189 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015190 first valid response.
15191
15192 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15193 servers return an error.
15194
15195
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151965.3.2. The resolvers section
15197----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015198
15199This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015200HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15201contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015202
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015203When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15204uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15205is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15206answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15207
15208When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015209used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015210
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015211 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15212 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15213 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015214
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015215 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15216 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015217
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015218 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15219 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15220 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015221
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015222For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15223following scenarios are possible:
15224
15225 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15226 ignored
15227
15228 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15229 applied
15230
15231 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15232 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15233
15234 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15235 retries the query with a new type
15236
15237 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15238 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015239
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015240As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015241a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015242<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015243
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015244
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015245resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015246 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015247
15248A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15249
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015250accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015251 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015252 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015253 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15254 by RFC 6891)
15255
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015256 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15257 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15258 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15259 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15260 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15261 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015262
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015263nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15264 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15265 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15266 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15267 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15268 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15269 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15270 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15271 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15272 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015273 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15274
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015275parse-resolv-conf
15276 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15277 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15278 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15279
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015280hold <status> <period>
15281 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15282 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015283 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015284 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015285 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15286 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15287 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15288
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015289 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015290
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015291resolve_retries <nb>
15292 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15293 giving up.
15294 Default value: 3
15295
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015296 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15297 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15298 type.
15299
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015300timeout <event> <time>
15301 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15302 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15303 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015304 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15305 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015306 Default value: 1s
15307 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015308 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015309 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015310 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15311 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15312
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015313 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015314
15315 resolvers mydns
15316 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15317 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015318 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015319 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015320 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015321 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015322 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015323 hold other 30s
15324 hold refused 30s
15325 hold nx 30s
15326 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015327 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015328 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015329
15330
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200153316. Cache
15332---------
15333
15334HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15335(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15336RAM.
15337
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015338The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15339blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015340
15341If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15342independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15343when we try to allocate a new one.
15344
15345The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15346
15347It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15348"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15349for more details.
15350
15351When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15352replaced by "<CACHE>".
15353
15354
153556.1. Limitation
15356----------------
15357
15358The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15359
15360- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015361- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15362 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15363 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015364- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15365- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015366- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15367 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15368 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015369- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15370 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015371- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15372 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15373 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015374
15375- If the request is not a GET
15376- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15377- If the request contains an Authorization header
15378
15379
153806.2. Setup
15381-----------
15382
15383To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15384the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15385
15386
153876.2.1. Cache section
15388---------------------
15389
15390cache <name>
15391 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15392 size of cache is mandatory.
15393
15394total-max-size <megabytes>
15395 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15396 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15397
15398max-object-size <bytes>
15399 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15400 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15401 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15402
15403max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015404 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015405 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15406 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15407 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15408 default.
15409
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015410process-vary <on/off>
15411 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015412 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15413 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15414 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015415 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015416
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015417max-secondary-entries <number>
15418 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15419 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15420 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15421
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015422
154236.2.2. Proxy section
15424---------------------
15425
15426http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15427 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15428 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15429 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15430 after this one.
15431
15432http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15433 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15434 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15435 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15436 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15437
15438
15439Example:
15440
15441 backend bck1
15442 mode http
15443
15444 http-request cache-use foobar
15445 http-response cache-store foobar
15446 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15447
15448 cache foobar
15449 total-max-size 4
15450 max-age 240
15451
15452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154537. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15454----------------------------------
15455
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015456HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015457client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15458The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15459these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15460but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15461data called patterns.
15462
15463
154647.1. ACL basics
15465---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015466
15467The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15468content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15469from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15470simple :
15471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015472 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015473 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015474 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15475 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015477The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15478adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015479
15480In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015482 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015483
15484This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15485Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15486and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015487an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15488conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15489as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15490are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015491
15492ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15493'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15494which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15495
15496There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15497performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015499The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15500specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15501this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015502methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15503ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015504
15505Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15506 - boolean
15507 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15508 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15509 - string
15510 - data block
15511
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015512Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15513converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15514would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15515The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15516which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15517
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015518Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15519keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15520fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15521which are summarized in the table below :
15522
15523 +---------------------+-----------------+
15524 | Sample or converter | Default |
15525 | output type | matching method |
15526 +---------------------+-----------------+
15527 | boolean | bool |
15528 +---------------------+-----------------+
15529 | integer | int |
15530 +---------------------+-----------------+
15531 | ip | ip |
15532 +---------------------+-----------------+
15533 | string | str |
15534 +---------------------+-----------------+
15535 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15536 +---------------------+-----------------+
15537
15538Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15539matching method, see below.
15540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015541The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15542 - boolean
15543 - integer or integer range
15544 - IP address / network
15545 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15546 - regular expression
15547 - hex block
15548
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015549The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15550
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015551 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15552 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015553 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015554 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015555 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015556 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015557 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015559The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15560read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15561if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15562lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15563will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15564beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015565a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015566lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15567exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15568
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015569The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15570parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15571ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15572a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15573check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15574
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015575The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15576socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15577file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015579Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15580loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15581
15582 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15583
15584In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15585the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15586case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15587as well.
15588
15589The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15590sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15591do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15592methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15593is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015594obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015595followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15596default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15597that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15598string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15599
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015600The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15601By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15602string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15603resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015604server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015605waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015606flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15607function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015609There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15610sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15611be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015612
15613 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15614 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015615 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15616 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15617 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15618 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015619
15620 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15621 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015622 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015623
15624 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015625 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015626
15627 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015628 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015629
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015630 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015631 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15632
15633 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15634 binary or string samples.
15635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015636 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15637 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015639 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15640 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15641 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015643 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15644 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015646 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15647 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15650 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015652 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15653 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015654 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015656 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15657 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15658 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015659
15660For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15661request, it is possible to do :
15662
15663 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15664
15665In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15666buffer, one would use the following acl :
15667
15668 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15669
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015670On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15671possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15672
15673 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015675All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15676criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15677method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15678to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15679criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15680the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015682If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015683the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15684For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015686 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15687 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15688 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15689 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015690
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015691
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015692The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15693types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15694combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15695brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15696default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015698 +-------------------------------------------------+
15699 | Input sample type |
15700 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015701 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015702 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15703 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15704 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015705 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015706 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015707 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015708 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015709 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015710 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015711 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015712 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015713 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015714 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015715 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015716 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015717 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015719 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015721 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015723 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015724 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015725 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15727 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15728 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015729
15730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157317.1.1. Matching booleans
15732------------------------
15733
15734In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15735Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15736When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15737that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15738
15739Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15740return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15741"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15742
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157447.1.2. Matching integers
15745------------------------
15746
15747Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15748enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15749to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15750
15751Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15752matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15753lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015754
15755For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15756unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15757representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15758
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015759As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15760two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15761instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15762ranges and operators.
15763
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015764For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015765operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15766Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15767of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015768
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015769Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015770
15771 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15772 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15773 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15774 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15775 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15776
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015777For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015778
15779 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15780
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015781This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15782
15783 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15784
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157867.1.3. Matching strings
15787-----------------------
15788
15789String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15790different forms :
15791
15792 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015793 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015794
15795 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015796 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015797
15798 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15799 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15800
15801 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15802 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15803
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015804 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015805 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15806 matches.
15807
15808 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15809 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15810 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015811
15812String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15813exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15814characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15815string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15816to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015817before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015818
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015819Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15820(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15821Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15822
15823Example:
15824 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15825 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15826
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158287.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15829---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015830
15831Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15832they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15833possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15834passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15835the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015836the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15837match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015838
15839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158407.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15841-------------------------------------
15842
15843It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15844not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15845a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15846to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15847digits may be used upper or lower case.
15848
15849Example :
15850 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15851 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15852
15853
158547.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15855---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015856
15857IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15858netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15859within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015860host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015861difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15862at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15863does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15864parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015865
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015866The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15867abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15868
15869 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15870 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15871 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15872 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15873 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15874 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15875 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15876 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15877
15878Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15879192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15880
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015881IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15882Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15883trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15884IPv6 patterns.
15885
15886HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15887following situations :
15888 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15889 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15890 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15891 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15892 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15893 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15894 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15895 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15896 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15897 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015899
159007.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15901----------------------------------
15902
15903Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15904combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15905
15906 - AND (implicit)
15907 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15908 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015910A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015912 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015914Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15915indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015917For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15918"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15919requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15920is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15921
15922 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015923 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15924 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15925 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015926
15927To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15928and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15929
15930 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15931 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15932 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15933 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15934
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015935 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015936 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15937 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15938 use_backend www if host_www
15939
15940It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15941expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15942be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15943the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15944
15945 The following rule :
15946
15947 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015948 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015949
15950 Can also be written that way :
15951
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015952 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015953
15954It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15955to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15956simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15957sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15958good use is the following :
15959
15960 With named ACLs :
15961
15962 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15963 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15964 monitor fail if site_dead
15965
15966 With anonymous ACLs :
15967
15968 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15969
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015970See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15971keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015972
15973
159747.3. Fetching samples
15975---------------------
15976
15977Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15978against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15979sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15980ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15981of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15982available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15983
15984This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15985Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15986compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15987deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15988
15989The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15990matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15991method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15992indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15993
15994As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15995when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15996mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15997the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15998ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15999
16000Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16001multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16002when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016003incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16004are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016005is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16006all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16007
16008Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16009 - name
16010 - name(arg1)
16011 - name(arg1,arg2)
16012
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016013
160147.3.1. Converters
16015-----------------
16016
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016017Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16018of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16019is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16020was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016021has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016022unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16023
16024These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16025sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16026the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016027support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016028
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016029A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16030support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16031supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16032(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16033bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016035The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016036
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001603751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16038 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16039 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16040 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16041 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16042 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16043
16044 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016045 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16046 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016047 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16048 frontend http-in
16049 bind *:8081
16050 default_backend servers
16051 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16052 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16053
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016054add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016055 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016056 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016057 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16058 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016059 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016060 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16061 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16062 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16063 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016064 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016065 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016066
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016067aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16068 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16069 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16070 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16071 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16072 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16073 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16074
16075 Example:
16076 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16077 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16078
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016079and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016080 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016081 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016082 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16083 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016084 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016085 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16086 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16087 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16088 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016089 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016090 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016091
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016092b64dec
16093 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16094 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016095 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16096 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016097
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016098base64
16099 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016100 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016101 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16102 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016103
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020016104be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
16105 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
16106 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
16107 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
16108 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
16109 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
16110
16111 Example:
16112 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
16113 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
16114 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
16115 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
16116
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020016117be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
16118 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
16119 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
16120 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
16121 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
16122 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
16123 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
16124
16125 Example:
16126 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
16127 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
16128 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
16129 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
16130
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016131bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016132 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016133 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016134 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016135 presence of a flag).
16136
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016137bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16138 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16139 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016140 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016141
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016142concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16143 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16144 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16145 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16146 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16147 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16148 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16149 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16150 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16151 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16152 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016153 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016154 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016155 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16156 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016157
16158 Example:
16159 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16160 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16161 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016162 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016163 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16164
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016165cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016166 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16167 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016168
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016169crc32([<avalanche>])
16170 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16171 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16172 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16173 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16174 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16175 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16176 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16177 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16178 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16179 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016180 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16181
16182crc32c([<avalanche>])
16183 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16184 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16185 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16186 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16187 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16188 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16189 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16190 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016191
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016192cut_crlf
16193 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16194 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16195 updated.
16196
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016197da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016198 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16199 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16200 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16201 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016202 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016203 configuration language.
16204
16205 Example:
16206 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016207 bind *:8881
16208 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016209 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016210
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016211debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16212 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16213 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16214 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16215 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16216 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16217 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16218 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16219 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16220 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16221 printable sample types.
16222
16223 Example:
16224 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016225
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016226digest(<algorithm>)
16227 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16228 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16229
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016230 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016231 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16232
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016233div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016234 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16235 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016236 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016237 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16238 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016239 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016240 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16241 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16242 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16243 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016244 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016245 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016246
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016247djb2([<avalanche>])
16248 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16249 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16250 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16251 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16252 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16253 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16254 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016255 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16256 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016257
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016258even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016259 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016260 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16261
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016262field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16263 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16264 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16265 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16266 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16267 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16268 fields.
16269
16270 Example :
16271 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16272 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16273 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16274 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16275 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016276
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016277fix_is_valid
16278 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16279 Information eXchange):
16280
16281 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16282 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016283 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016284 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016285 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016286 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16287 checksum
16288
16289 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16290 the server can be parsed.
16291
16292 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16293 message, false if not.
16294
16295 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16296
16297 Example:
16298 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16299 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16300
16301fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16302 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16303 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16304 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16305 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016306 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016307 added.
16308
16309 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16310 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16311 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16312 fix_is_valid converter.
16313
16314 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16315
16316 Example:
16317 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16318 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16319 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16320 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16321 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16322
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016323hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016324 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016325 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016326 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016327 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016328
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016329hex2i
16330 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016331 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016332
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016333htonl
16334 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16335 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16336 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16337 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16338
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016339hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016340 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16341 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16342 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16343 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16344
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016345 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016346 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16347
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016348http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016349 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16350 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016351 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16352 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16353 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16354 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16355 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16356 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16357 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16358 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016359
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016360iif(<true>,<false>)
16361 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16362 string otherwise.
16363
16364 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016365 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016366
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016367in_table(<table>)
16368 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16369 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16370 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016371 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016372 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16373
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016374ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016375 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016376 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016377 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16378 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16379 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16380 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16381 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016382
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016383json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016384 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016385 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016386 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016387 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16388 of errors:
16389 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16390 bytes, ...)
16391 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16392 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16393
16394 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16395 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16396 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16397 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16398 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16399 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016400 - "ascii" : never fails;
16401 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16402 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016403 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016404 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016405 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16406 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16407
16408 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016409 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016410
16411 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016412 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016413 capture request header user-agent len 150
16414 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016415
16416 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16417 GET / HTTP/1.0
16418 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16419
16420 Output log:
16421 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16422
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016423json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16424 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16425 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16426 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16427 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16428
16429 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16430 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16431
16432 Example:
16433 # get a integer value from the request body
16434 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16435 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16436
16437 # get a key with '.' in the name
16438 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16439 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16440
16441 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16442 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16443
16444 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16445 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16446
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016447language(<value>[,<default>])
16448 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16449 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16450 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16451 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16452 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16453 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16454 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16455 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16456 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016457 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016458 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16459 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016460
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016461 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016462
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016463 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16464 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016465
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016466 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16467 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16468 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16469 use_backend spanish if es
16470 use_backend french if fr
16471 use_backend english if en
16472 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016473
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016474length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016475 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16476 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16477 type. The result is of type integer.
16478
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016479lower
16480 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16481 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16482 type. The result is of type string.
16483
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016484ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16485 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16486 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16487 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16488 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16489 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16490 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16491
16492 Example :
16493
16494 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016495 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016496 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16497
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016498ltrim(<chars>)
16499 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16500 representation of the input sample.
16501
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016502map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16503map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16504map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16505 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16506 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16507 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16508 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16509 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16510 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16511 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16512 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016513
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016514 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16515 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16516 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016517
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016518 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016519 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016520
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016521 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16522 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16523 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16524 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016525 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16526 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016527 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16528 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16529 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16530 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16531 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16532 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16533 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16534 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016535 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16536 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16537 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016538 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16539 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16540 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16541 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16542 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016543
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016544 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16545 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16546 the corresponding match text.
16547
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016548 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16549 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16550 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16551 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16552 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016553
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016554 Example :
16555
16556 # this is a comment and is ignored
16557 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16558 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16559 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16560 | | | `---------- value
16561 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16562 | `---------------------------- key
16563 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16564
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016565mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016566 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16567 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016568 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016569 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016570 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016571 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16572 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16573 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16574 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016575 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016576 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016577
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016578mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016579 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16580 <packettype>.
16581 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16582 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16583 from.
16584 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16585 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16586 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16587
16588 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16589 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16590 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16591 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16592
16593 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16594 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16595 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16596 packets only):
16597 17: Session Expiry Interval
16598 33: Receive Maximum
16599 39: Maximum Packet Size
16600 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16601 25: Request Response Information
16602 23: Request Problem Information
16603 21: Authentication Method
16604 22: Authentication Data
16605 18: Will Delay Interval
16606 1: Payload Format Indicator
16607 2: Message Expiry Interval
16608 3: Content Type
16609 8: Response Topic
16610 9: Correlation Data
16611 Not supported yet:
16612 38: User Property
16613
16614 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16615 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16616 packets only):
16617 17: Session Expiry Interval
16618 33: Receive Maximum
16619 36: Maximum QoS
16620 37: Retain Available
16621 39: Maximum Packet Size
16622 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16623 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16624 31: Reason String
16625 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16626 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16627 42: Shared Subscription Available
16628 19: Server Keep Alive
16629 26: Response Information
16630 28: Server Reference
16631 21: Authentication Method
16632 22: Authentication Data
16633 Not supported yet:
16634 38: User Property
16635
16636 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16637 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16638 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16639 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16640
16641 Example:
16642
16643 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16644 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16645 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16646 if data_in_buffer
16647 # do the same as above
16648 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16649 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16650 if data_in_buffer
16651
16652mqtt_is_valid
16653 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16654
16655 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16656 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16657 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16658 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16659
16660 Example:
16661
16662 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016663 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016664
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016665mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016666 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016667 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16668 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016669 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016670 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016671 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016672 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16673 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16674 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16675 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016676 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016677 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016678
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016679nbsrv
16680 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16681 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16682 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16683 map lookup.
16684
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016685neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016686 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16687 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16688 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16689 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016690
16691not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016692 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016693 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016694 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016695 absence of a flag).
16696
16697odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016698 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016699 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16700
16701or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016702 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016703 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016704 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16705 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016706 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016707 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16708 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16709 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16710 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016711 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016712 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016713
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016714protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16715 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16716 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16717 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16718 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16719 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16720 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16721 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16722 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16723 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16724 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16725 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16726
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016727regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016728 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16729 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16730 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16731 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16732 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16733 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16734 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16735 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16736 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016737 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16738 of characters with other ones.
16739
16740 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16741 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16742 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16743 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16744 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16745 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016746
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016747 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016748
16749 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16750 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16751 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016752 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016753
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016754 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16755 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16756
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016757 # capture groups and backreferences
16758 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016759 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016760 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16761
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016762capture-req(<id>)
16763 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16764 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16765
16766 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016767 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16768 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016769
16770capture-res(<id>)
16771 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16772 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16773
16774 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016775 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16776 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016777
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016778rtrim(<chars>)
16779 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16780 of the input sample.
16781
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016782sdbm([<avalanche>])
16783 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16784 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16785 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16786 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16787 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16788 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16789 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016790 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16791 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016792
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016793secure_memcmp(<var>)
16794 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16795 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16796 match.
16797
16798 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16799 performed in constant time.
16800
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016801 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016802 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16803
16804 Example :
16805
16806 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16807 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16808 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16809 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16810
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016811set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016812 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16813 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16814 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016815 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016816 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16817 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016818 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016819 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16820 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016821 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016822 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016823
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016824sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016825 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016826 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16827
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016828sha2([<bits>])
16829 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16830 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16831
16832 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16833 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16834
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016835 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016836 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16837
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016838srv_queue
16839 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16840 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16841 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16842 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16843 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16844
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016845strcmp(<var>)
16846 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16847 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16848 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16849 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16850 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16851 shorter).
16852
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016853 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16854 strings in constant time.
16855
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016856 Example :
16857
16858 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16859 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16860 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16861
16862
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016863sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016864 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16865 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016866 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016867 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16868 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016869 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016870 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16871 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016872 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016873 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16874 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016875 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016876 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016877
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016878table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16879 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16880 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16881 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16882 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16883 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16884 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16885
16886
16887table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16888 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16889 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16890 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16891 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16892 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16893 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16894
16895table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16896 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16897 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016898 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016899 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16900 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16901
16902table_conn_cur(<table>)
16903 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16904 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16905 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16906 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16907 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16908
16909table_conn_rate(<table>)
16910 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16911 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16912 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16913 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16914 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16915
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020016916table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
16917 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16918 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16919 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
16920 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
16921 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
16922 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
16923 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
16924 data-type).
16925 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
16926
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016927table_gpt0(<table>)
16928 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16929 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16930 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16931 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16932 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16933
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020016934table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
16935 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16936 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16937 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
16938 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
16939 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
16940 between 0 and 99.
16941 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
16942 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
16943 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
16944 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
16945
16946table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
16947 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
16948 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16949 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
16950 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
16951 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
16952 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
16953 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
16954 value 0.
16955 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
16956 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
16957 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
16958
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016959table_gpc0(<table>)
16960 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16961 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16962 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16963 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16964 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16965
16966table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16967 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16968 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16969 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16970 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16971 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16972 sample fetch keyword.
16973
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016974table_gpc1(<table>)
16975 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16976 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16977 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16978 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16979 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16980
16981table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16982 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16983 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16984 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16985 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16986 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16987 sample fetch keyword.
16988
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016989table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16990 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16991 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016992 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016993 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16994 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16995
16996table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16997 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16998 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16999 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17000 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17001 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17002 keyword.
17003
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017004table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17005 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17006 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17007 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17008 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17009 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17010
17011table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17012 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17013 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17014 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17015 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17016 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17017 keyword.
17018
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017019table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17020 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17021 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017022 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017023 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17024 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17025
17026table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17027 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17028 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17029 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17030 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17031 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17032 keyword.
17033
17034table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17035 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17036 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017037 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017038 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17039 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17040 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17041 keyword.
17042
17043table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17044 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17045 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017046 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017047 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17048 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17049 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17050 keyword.
17051
17052table_server_id(<table>)
17053 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17054 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17055 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17056 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17057 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17058 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17059
17060table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17061 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17062 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017063 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017064 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17065 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17066 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17067 keyword.
17068
17069table_sess_rate(<table>)
17070 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17071 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17072 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17073 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17074 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17075 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17076 keyword.
17077
17078table_trackers(<table>)
17079 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17080 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17081 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17082 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17083 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17084 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17085 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17086 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17087 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17088 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17089
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017090ub64dec
17091 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17092 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17093 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17094
17095 Example:
17096 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17097 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17098
17099ub64enc
17100 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17101
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017102upper
17103 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17104 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17105 type. The result is of type string.
17106
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017107url_dec([<in_form>])
17108 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17109 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17110 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17111 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17112 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17113 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017114
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017115url_enc([<enc_type>])
17116 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17117 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17118 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17119 optional argument is here for future changes.
17120
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017121ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017122 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017123 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17124 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17125 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017126 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17127 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17128 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17129 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017130 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017131 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17132 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017133
17134 Example:
17135 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17136 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17137
17138 message Point {
17139 int32 latitude = 1;
17140 int32 longitude = 2;
17141 }
17142
17143 message PPoint {
17144 Point point = 59;
17145 }
17146
17147 message Rectangle {
17148 // One corner of the rectangle.
17149 PPoint lo = 48;
17150 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17151 PPoint hi = 49;
17152 }
17153
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017154 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17155 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17156 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017157
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017158 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17159 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017160 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017161 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17162
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017163 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017164
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017165 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017166
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017167 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17168 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17169 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017170
17171 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17172 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17173 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17174
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017175 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17176 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17177 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017178
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017179
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017180unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017181 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17182 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17183 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17184 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17185 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17186 response),
17187 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17188 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17189 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17190 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17191
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017192utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17193 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17194 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17195 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17196 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17197 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17198 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17199
17200 Example :
17201
17202 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017203 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017204 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17205
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017206word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17207 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17208 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17209 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017210 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017211 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17212 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17213
17214 Example :
17215 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17216 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17217 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17218 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17219 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017220 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017221
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017222wt6([<avalanche>])
17223 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17224 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17225 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17226 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17227 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17228 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17229 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017230 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17231 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017232
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017233xor(<value>)
17234 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017235 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017236 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017237 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017238 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017239 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17240 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017241 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017242 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17243 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017244 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017245 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017246
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017247xxh3([<seed>])
17248 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17249 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17250 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17251 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17252 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17253 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17254 considered as cryptographically secure.
17255
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017256xxh32([<seed>])
17257 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17258 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17259 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17260 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17261 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17262 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17263 as cryptographically secure.
17264
17265xxh64([<seed>])
17266 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17267 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17268 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17269 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17270 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17271 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17272 as cryptographically secure.
17273
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017274
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172757.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017276--------------------------------------------
17277
17278A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17279not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17280"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17281The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17282
17283always_false : boolean
17284 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17285 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17286
17287always_true : boolean
17288 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17289 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17290
17291avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017292 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017293 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17294 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17295 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17296 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17297 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17298 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17299 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17300 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17301 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17302 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17303 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17304 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17305 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017307be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017308 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17309 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17310 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17311 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017312 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17313
17314be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17315 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17316 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17317 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17318 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17319 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017320 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17321 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017322
17323 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17324 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17325 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017327be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17328 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17329 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17330 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017331 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017332 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17333 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017334
17335 Example :
17336 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17337 backend dynamic
17338 mode http
17339 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17340 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017341
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017342bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017343 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17344 of the string.
17345
17346bool(<bool>) : bool
17347 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17348 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017350connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17351 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017352 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017353 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17354 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017355
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017356 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017357 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017358 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17359
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017360 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17361 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017362
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017363 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017364 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017365 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017366 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017367 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017368 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017369 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017370
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017371 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17372 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017373 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017374 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017375
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017376cpu_calls : integer
17377 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17378 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17379 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17380 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17381 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17382 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17383
17384cpu_ns_avg : integer
17385 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17386 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17387 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17388 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17389 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17390 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17391 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17392 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17393 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17394 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17395 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17396
17397cpu_ns_tot : integer
17398 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17399 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17400 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17401 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17402 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17403 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17404 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17405 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17406 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17407 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17408 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17409 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17410 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17411
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017412date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017413 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017414
17415 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17416 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17417 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017418 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17419
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017420 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17421 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17422 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17423 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17424 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17425
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017426 Example :
17427
17428 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17429 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017430
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017431 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17432 # millisecond granularity
17433 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17434
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017435date_us : integer
17436 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17437 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17438 from the same timeval structure.
17439
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017440distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17441 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17442 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17443 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17444 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017445 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017446 list of supported tokens.
17447
17448distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17449 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17450 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17451 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17452 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017453 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017454 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17455 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17456 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17457 supported tokens.
17458
17459 Example :
17460 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17461 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17462 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17463 # send large files to the big farm
17464 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17465
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017466env(<name>) : string
17467 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17468 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17469 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17470 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17471 certain way.
17472
17473 Examples :
17474 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17475 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17476
17477 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17478 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017480fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17481 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017482 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17483 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017484 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17485 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017486 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017487 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17488 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017489
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017490fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17491 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17492 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17493 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017495fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17496 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17497 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17498 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17499 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17500 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17501 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17502 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17503 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017504
17505 Example :
17506 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17507 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17508 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17509 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17510 frontend mail
17511 bind :25
17512 mode tcp
17513 maxconn 100
17514 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17515 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17516 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17517 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017518
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017519hostname : string
17520 Returns the system hostname.
17521
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017522int(<integer>) : signed integer
17523 Returns a signed integer.
17524
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017525ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17526 Returns an ipv4.
17527
17528ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17529 Returns an ipv6.
17530
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017531lat_ns_avg : integer
17532 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17533 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17534 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17535 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17536 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17537 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17538 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17539 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17540 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017541 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17542 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17543 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17544 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17545 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17546 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017547
17548lat_ns_tot : integer
17549 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17550 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17551 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17552 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17553 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17554 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17555 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17556 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17557 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017558 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17559 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17560 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17561 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17562 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017563 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17564 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17565 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17566 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17567 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17568 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17569
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017570meth(<method>) : method
17571 Returns a method.
17572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017573nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17574 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17575 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17576 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017577 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17578 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17579 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017580
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017581prio_class : integer
17582 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17583 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17584 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17585
17586prio_offset : integer
17587 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17588 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17589 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17590 set-priority-offset".
17591
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017592proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020017593 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
17594 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017596queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017597 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17598 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17599 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017600 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17601 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17602 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17603 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17604 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17605
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017606rand([<range>]) : integer
17607 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17608 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17609 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17610 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17611 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017613srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17614 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17615 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17616 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17617 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17618 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017619 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17620 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17621
17622srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17623 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17624 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17625 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17626 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17627 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17628 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17629 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17630
17631 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17632 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017633
17634srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17635 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17636 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17637 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017638 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017639 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17640 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17641 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17642
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017643srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17644 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17645 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17646 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17647 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17648 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17649 fetch methods.
17650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017651srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17652 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17653 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017654 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017655 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17656 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017657 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017658 overloading servers).
17659
17660 Example :
17661 # Redirect to a separate back
17662 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17663 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17664 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17665
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017666srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017667 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17668 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17669 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17670
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017671srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017672 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17673 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17674 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17675
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017676srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017677 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17678 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17679 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17680
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017681stopping : boolean
17682 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17683 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17684 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17685
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017686str(<string>) : string
17687 Returns a string.
17688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017689table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17690 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17691 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17692
17693table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17694 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17695 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17696 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17697
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017698thread : integer
17699 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17700 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17701 and debugging purposes.
17702
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017703uuid([<version>]) : string
17704 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17705 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17706 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17707
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017708var(<var-name>) : undefined
17709 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017710 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17711 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017712 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017713 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17714 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017715 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017716 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17717 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017718 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017719 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017720
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200177217.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017722----------------------------------
17723
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017724The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017725closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17726methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17727sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17728TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017729the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17730counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017731"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17732used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17733can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17734Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17735table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17736tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17737currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017738
Remi Tricot-Le Breton942c1672021-09-01 15:52:15 +020017739bc_conn_err : integer
17740 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
17741 connection. See the "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
17742 and their corresponding error message.
17743
17744bc_conn_err_str : string
17745 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
17746 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
17747 "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
17748 corresponding error message.
17749
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017750bc_dst : ip
17751 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17752 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17753 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17754 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17755
17756bc_dst_port : integer
17757 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017758 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017759
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017760bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017761 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17762 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17763 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17764
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017765bc_src : ip
17766 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017767 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017768 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17769 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17770
17771bc_src_port : integer
17772 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017773 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017775be_id : integer
17776 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017777 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17778 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017779
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017780be_name : string
17781 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017782 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17783 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017784
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017785be_server_timeout : integer
17786 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17787 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17788 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17789
17790be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17791 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17792 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17793 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17794
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017795cur_server_timeout : integer
17796 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17797 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17798 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17799
17800cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17801 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17802 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17803 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017805dst : ip
17806 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17807 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17808 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17809 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017810 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17811 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17812 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17813 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17814 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17815 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017816
17817dst_conn : integer
17818 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17819 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17820 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17821 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17822 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17823 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17824 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17825 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017826
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017827dst_is_local : boolean
17828 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17829 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17830 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17831 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017832 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017833 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17834 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17835 it only once per connection.
17836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017837dst_port : integer
17838 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17839 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17840 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17841 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17842 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17843 an HTTP header.
17844
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017845fc_conn_err : integer
17846 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
17847 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
17848 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050017849 described in section 8.2.5). See the "fc_conn_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017850 error codes and their corresponding error message.
17851
17852fc_conn_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050017853 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020017854 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
17855 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.5). See below for a
17856 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
17857
17858 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17859 | ID | message |
17860 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17861 | 0 | "Success" |
17862 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
17863 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
17864 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
17865 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
17866 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
17867 | 6 | "General socket error" |
17868 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
17869 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
17870 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
17871 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
17872 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17873 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17874 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
17875 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
17876 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
17877 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
17878 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
17879 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
17880 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
17881 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
17882 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
17883 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
17884 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
17885 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
17886 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
17887 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
17888 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
17889 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
17890 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
17891 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
17892 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
17893 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
17894 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
17895 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
17896 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
17897 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
17898 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
17899 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
17900 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
17901 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
17902 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
17903 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
17904 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
17905
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017906fc_http_major : integer
17907 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17908 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17909 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17910
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017911fc_pp_authority : string
17912 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17913 if any.
17914
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017915fc_pp_unique_id : string
17916 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17917 if any.
17918
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017919fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17920 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17921 header.
17922
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017923fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17924 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17925 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17926 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17927 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17928 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17929 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17930
17931fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17932 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17933 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17934 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17935 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17936 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17937 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17938
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017939fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017940 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17941 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17942 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17943 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17944
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017945fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017946 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17947 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17948 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17949 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17950
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017951fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017952 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17953 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17954 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17955 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17956
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017957fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017958 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17959 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17960 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17961 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17962
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017963fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017964 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17965 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17966 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17967 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17968
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017969fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017970 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17971 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17972 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17973 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17974
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017975fe_defbe : string
17976 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17977 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017979fe_id : integer
17980 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017981 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017982 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17983
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017984fe_name : string
17985 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17986 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17987 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17988
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017989fe_client_timeout : integer
17990 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17991 current frontend.
17992
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017993sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017994sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17995sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17996sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017997 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17998 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17999 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
18000
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018001sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018002sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18003sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18004sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018005 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
18006 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18007 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
18008
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018009sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18010 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18011 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18012 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18013 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18014 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18015 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18016 will always return zero.
18017 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18018 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18019
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018020sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018021sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18022sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18023sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018024 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18025 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018026 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18027 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18028 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018029
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018030 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018031 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18032 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018033 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18034 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18035 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018036 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18037 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18038
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018039sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18040sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18041sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18042sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18043 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18044 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18045 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18046 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18047 when a first ACL was verified.
18048
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018049sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018050sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18051sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18052sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018053 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018054 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18055
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018056sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018057sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18058sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18059sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018060 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18061 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18062 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18063
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018064sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018065sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18066sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18067sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018068 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18069 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18070 See also src_conn_rate.
18071
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018072sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18073 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
18074 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
18075 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
18076 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18077 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
18078 index, zero is returned.
18079 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18080 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
18081
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018082sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018083sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18084sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18085sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018086 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018087 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018088
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018089sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18090sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18091sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18092sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18093 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18094 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18095
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018096sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18097 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18098 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18099 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18100 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18101 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18102 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18103 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18104
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018105sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18106sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18107sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18108sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18109 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18110 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18111
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018112sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18113 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18114 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18115 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18116 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18117 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18118 between 0 and 2.
18119 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18120 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18121 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18122 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18123 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18124
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018125sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018126sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18127sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18128sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018129 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18130 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18131 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018132 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18133 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18134 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018135
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018136sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18137sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18138sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18139sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18140 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18141 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18142 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18143 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18144 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18145 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18146
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018147sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018148sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18149sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18150sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018151 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018152 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18153 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18154
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018155sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018156sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18157sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18158sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018159 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18160 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18161 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18162 src_http_err_rate.
18163
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018164sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18165sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18166sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18167sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18168 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18169 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18170 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18171
18172sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18173sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18174sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18175sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18176 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18177 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18178 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18179 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18180
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018181sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018182sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18183sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18184sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018185 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018186 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18187 src_http_req_cnt.
18188
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018189sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018190sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18191sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18192sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018193 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18194 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18195 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18196 src_http_req_rate.
18197
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018198sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18199 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18200 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18201 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18202 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18203 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18204 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18205 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18206 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18207 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18208
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018209sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018210sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18211sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18212sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018213 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018214 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18215 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18216 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18217 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018218
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018219 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018220 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18221 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018222 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18223
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018224sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18225sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18226sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18227sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18228 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18229 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18230 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18231 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18232 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18233
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018234sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018235sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18236sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18237sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018238 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18239 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18240 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018241
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018242sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018243sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18244sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18245sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018246 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18247 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18248 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018249
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018250sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018251sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18252sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18253sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018254 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018255 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18256 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18257 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018258 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018259 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18260
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018261sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018262sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18263sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18264sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018265 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18266 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18267 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18268 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18269 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018270 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018271
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018272sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018273sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18274sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18275sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018276 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18277 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18278 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18279
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018280sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018281sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18282sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18283sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018284 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18285 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018286 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018287 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18288 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018289 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18290 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18291 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018293so_id : integer
18294 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18295 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18296 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018297
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018298so_name : string
18299 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18300 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18301 strings instead of integers.
18302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018303src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018304 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018305 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18306 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18307 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018308 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18309 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18310 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018311 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18312 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18313 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18314 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18315 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18316 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18317 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018318
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018319 Example:
18320 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18321 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18322
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018323src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18324 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18325 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18326 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018327 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018329src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18330 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18331 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018332 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018333 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018334
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018335src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18336 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18337 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18338 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
18339 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18340 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
18341 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18342 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18343 See also sc_clr_gpc.
18344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018345src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18346 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18347 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18348 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18349 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18350 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18351 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018352
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018353 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018354 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18355 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18356 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18357 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018358 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018359 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18360 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18361
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018362src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18363 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18364 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18365 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18366 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18367 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18368 was verified.
18369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018370src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018371 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018372 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018373 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018374 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018376src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018377 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018378 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18379 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018380 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018382src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18383 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18384 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18385 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018386 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018387
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018388src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18389 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
18390 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18391 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18392 is an integer between 0 and 99.
18393 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
18394 is returned.
18395 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
18396 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18397 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
18398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018399src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018400 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018401 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018402 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018403 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018404
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018405src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18406 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18407 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18408 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18409 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18410
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018411src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18412 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18413 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18414 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
18415 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18416 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
18417 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18418
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018419src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18420 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18421 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18422 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18423 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18424
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018425src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18426 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18427 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
18428 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18429 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
18430 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18431 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
18432 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18433 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18434 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18435 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018437src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018438 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018439 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018440 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18441 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018442 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18443 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18444 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018445
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018446src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18447 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18448 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18449 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18450 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18451 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18452 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18453 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018455src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018456 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018457 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018458 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018459 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018460 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018462src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18463 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18464 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18465 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18466 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018467 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018468
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018469src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18470 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18471 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018472 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018473 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18474 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18475
18476src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18477 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18478 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18479 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18480 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18481 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18482 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018484src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018485 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018486 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18487 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018488 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018490src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18491 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18492 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18493 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018494 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018495 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018496
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018497src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18498 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
18499 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18500 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
18501 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18502 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
18503 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18504 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18505 See also sc_inc_gpc.
18506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018507src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18508 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18509 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18510 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018511 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018512 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18513 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018514
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018515 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018516 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018517 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018518 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018519
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018520src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18521 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18522 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18523 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18524 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18525 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18526 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18527
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018528src_is_local : boolean
18529 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18530 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18531 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18532 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018533 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018534 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18535 once per connection.
18536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018537src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018538 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18539 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18540 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18541 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18542 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018544src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018545 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18546 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18547 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18548 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18549 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018551src_port : integer
18552 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18553 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18554 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18555 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018557src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018558 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018559 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18560 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18561 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018562 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018564src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18565 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18566 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18567 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18568 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018569 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018571src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18572 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18573 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18574 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18575 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18576 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18577 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18578 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18579 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018580
18581 Example :
18582 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18583 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18584 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18585 listen ssh
18586 bind :22
18587 mode tcp
18588 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018589 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018590 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018591 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018593srv_id : integer
18594 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18595 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018596 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018597
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018598srv_name : string
18599 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18600 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018601 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018602
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200186037.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018604----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018605
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018606The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018607closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18608when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18609usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018610future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018611
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001861251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18613 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18614 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18615 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18616 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18617 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18618
18619 Example :
18620 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18621 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18622 # the request.
18623 frontend http-in
18624 bind *:8081
18625 default_backend servers
18626 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18627 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18628
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018629ssl_bc : boolean
18630 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18631 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018632 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18633 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018634
18635ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18636 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018637 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18638 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018639
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018640ssl_bc_alpn : string
18641 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18642 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018643 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018644 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18645 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18646 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18647 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18648 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018649 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18650 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018651
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018652ssl_bc_cipher : string
18653 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018654 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18655 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018656
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018657ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18658 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18659 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18660 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018661 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018662
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020018663ssl_bc_hsk_err : integer
18664 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18665 returns the ID of the latest error that happened during the handshake on the
18666 backend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. In order to get a text
18667 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_hsk_err_str"
18668 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
18669 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
18670 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
18671
18672ssl_bc_hsk_err_str : string
18673 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18674 returns a string representation of the latest error that happened during the
18675 handshake on the backend side. See also "ssl_fc_hsk_err".
18676
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018677ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18678 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18679 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018680 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18681 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018682
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018683ssl_bc_npn : string
18684 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18685 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018686 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018687 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18688 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18689 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18690 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018691 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18692 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018693
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018694ssl_bc_protocol : string
18695 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018696 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18697 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018698
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018699ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018700 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018701 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018702 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18703 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018704
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018705ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18706 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18707 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18708 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018709 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018710
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018711ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18712 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18713 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018714 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18715 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018716
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018717ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18718 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18719 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18720 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018721 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018722
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018723ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18724 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018725 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18726 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018728ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18729 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18730 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18731 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18732 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18733 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018735ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18736 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18737 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18738 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18739 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018740
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018741ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018742 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18743 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18744 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018745 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018746 does not support resumed sessions.
18747
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018748ssl_c_der : binary
18749 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18750 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18751 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018753ssl_c_err : integer
18754 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18755 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18756 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18757 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18758 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018759
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018760ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018761 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18762 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18763 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18764 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18765 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18766 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18767 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18768 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018769 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18770 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18771 LDAP v3.
18772 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18773 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018775ssl_c_key_alg : string
18776 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18777 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18778 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018780ssl_c_notafter : string
18781 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18782 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18783 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018785ssl_c_notbefore : string
18786 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18787 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18788 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018789
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018790ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018791 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18792 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18793 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18794 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18795 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18796 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18797 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18798 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018799 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18800 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18801 LDAP v3.
18802 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18803 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018805ssl_c_serial : binary
18806 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18807 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18808 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018810ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18811 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18812 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18813 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018814 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18815 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18816
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018817 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018818 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018820ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18821 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18822 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18823 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018825ssl_c_used : boolean
18826 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18827 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018829ssl_c_verify : integer
18830 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18831 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18832 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18833 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018835ssl_c_version : integer
18836 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18837 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018838
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018839ssl_f_der : binary
18840 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18841 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18842 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18843
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018844ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018845 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18846 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18847 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18848 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018849 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018850 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18851 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18852 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018853 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18854 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18855 LDAP v3.
18856 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18857 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018859ssl_f_key_alg : string
18860 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18861 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18862 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018864ssl_f_notafter : string
18865 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18866 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18867 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018869ssl_f_notbefore : string
18870 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18871 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18872 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018873
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018874ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018875 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18876 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18877 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18878 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18879 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18880 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18881 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18882 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018883 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18884 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18885 LDAP v3.
18886 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18887 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018889ssl_f_serial : binary
18890 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18891 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18892 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018893
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018894ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18895 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18896 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18897 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018899ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18900 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18901 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18902 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018904ssl_f_version : integer
18905 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18906 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18907
18908ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018909 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18910 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18911 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018913 Example :
18914 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18915 listen http-https
18916 bind :80
18917 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18918 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18919
18920ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18921 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18922 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18923
18924ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018925 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018926 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018927 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018928 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18929 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18930 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18931 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18932 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18933 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018935ssl_fc_cipher : string
18936 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18937 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018938
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018939ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
18940 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18941 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018942 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018943 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
18944 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
18945 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018946
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018947 Example:
18948 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
18949 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18950 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18951 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18952 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
18953 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
18954 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
18955 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
18956 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
18957
18958ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018959 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018960 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018961 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
18962 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018963 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
18964 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018965
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018966ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018967 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018968 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018969 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018970 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
18971 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
18972 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
18973 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
18974 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
18975 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018976
18977ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018978 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018979 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
18980 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018981
18982ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
18983 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
18984 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020018985 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020018986
18987 Example:
18988 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
18989 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18990 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18991 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
18992 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
18993 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
18994 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
18995 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
18996 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
18997
18998ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
18999 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
19000 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019001 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019002 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19003 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
19004 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19005
19006 Example:
19007 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19008 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19009 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19010 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19011 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19012 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19013 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19014 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19015 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19016
19017ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19018 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
19019 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019020 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019021 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19022 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
19023 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19024
19025 Example:
19026 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19027 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19028 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19029 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19030 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19031 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19032 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19033 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19034 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019035
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019036ssl_fc_client_random : binary
19037 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19038 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19039 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19040
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019041ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
19042 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19043 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19044 transport layer.
19045 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19046 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19047 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19048 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19049
19050ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19051 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19052 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19053 transport layer.
19054 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19055 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19056 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19057 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19058
19059ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
19060 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19061 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19062 transport layer.
19063 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19064 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19065 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19066 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19067
19068ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
19069 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19070 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19071 transport layer.
19072 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19073 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19074 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19075 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19076
19077ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
19078 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19079 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19080 transport layer.
19081 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19082 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19083 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19084 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019086ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019087 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
19088 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010019089 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
19090 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
19091 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
19092 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019093
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020019094ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
19095 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
19096 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
19097 wait until the handshake happened.
19098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019099ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
19100 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019101 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
19102 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019103 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019104 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019105
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c6898e2021-07-29 09:45:51 +020019106ssl_fc_hsk_err : integer
19107 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19108 returns the ID of the latest error that happened during the handshake on the
19109 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. Any error happening during
19110 the client's certificate verification process will not be raised through this
19111 fetch but via the existing "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and
19112 "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get a text description of this
19113 error code, you can either use the "ssl_fc_hsk_err_str" sample fetch or use
19114 the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code in hexadecimal
19115 representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL library's
19116 documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
19117
19118ssl_fc_hsk_err_str : string
19119 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19120 returns a string representation of the latest error that happened during the
19121 handshake on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
19122 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
19123 also "ssl_fc_hsk_err".
19124
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020019125ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019126 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010019127 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
19128 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019130ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019131 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019132 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019133 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
19134 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
19135 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
19136 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
19137 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
19138 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020019139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019140ssl_fc_protocol : string
19141 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
19142 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019143
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019144ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
19145 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
19146 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019147 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
19148 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019149
19150 Example:
19151 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19152 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19153 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19154 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19155 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19156 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19157 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19158 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19159 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19160
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019161ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019162 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019163 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
19164 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019165
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019166ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19167 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19168 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19169 transport layer.
19170 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19171 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19172 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19173 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19174
19175ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
19176 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19177 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19178 transport layer.
19179 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19180 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19181 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19182 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19183
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019184ssl_fc_server_random : binary
19185 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19186 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19187 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019189ssl_fc_session_id : binary
19190 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
19191 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
19192 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
19193 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019194
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019195ssl_fc_session_key : binary
19196 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
19197 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19198 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
19199 BoringSSL.
19200
19201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019202ssl_fc_sni : string
19203 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
19204 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019205 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019206 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
19207 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
19208
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019209 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019210 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019211 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019212 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020019213 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019215 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019216 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19217 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019219ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19220 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19221 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019222
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019223ssl_s_der : binary
19224 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19225 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19226 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19227
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019228ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19229 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19230 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19231 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019232 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019233 does not support resumed sessions.
19234
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019235ssl_s_key_alg : string
19236 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19237 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19238 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19239
19240ssl_s_notafter : string
19241 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19242 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19243 transport layer.
19244
19245ssl_s_notbefore : string
19246 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19247 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19248 transport layer.
19249
19250ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19251 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19252 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19253 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19254 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19255 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19256 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019257 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19258 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019259 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19260 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19261 LDAP v3.
19262 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19263 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19264
19265ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19266 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19267 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19268 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19269 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19270 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19271 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019272 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19273 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019274 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19275 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19276 LDAP v3.
19277 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19278 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19279
19280ssl_s_serial : binary
19281 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19282 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19283 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19284
19285ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19286 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19287 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19288 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19289
19290ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19291 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19292 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19293 layer.
19294
19295ssl_s_version : integer
19296 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19297 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019298
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200192997.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019300------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019302Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19303sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19304only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19305For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19306be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19307can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19308sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19309for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19310content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019311
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019312Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19313 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019314 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019315 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19316 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19317 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19318 sample expression). So be careful.
19319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019320payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019321 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019322 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19323 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019325payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19326 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019327 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019328 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019330req.len : integer
19331req_len : integer (deprecated)
19332 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19333 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19334 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19335 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19336 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019337 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019338 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19339 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019341req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19342 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019343 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19344 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19345 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19346 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019348 ACL alternatives :
19349 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019351req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19352 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19353 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19354 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19355 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019357 ACL alternatives :
19358 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019360 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019362req.proto_http : boolean
19363req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19364 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19365 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19366 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19367 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19368 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19369 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19370 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019372 Example:
19373 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19374 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19375 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019376 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019378req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19379rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19380 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19381 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19382 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19383 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19384 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19385 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19386 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019388 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19389 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19390 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19391 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19392 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19393 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019395 ACL derivatives :
19396 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019398 Example :
19399 listen tse-farm
19400 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19401 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19402 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19403 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19404 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19405 persist rdp-cookie
19406 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19407 # This is only useful makes sense if
19408 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19409 stick-table type string size 204800
19410 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19411 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19412 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019414 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
19415 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019417req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19418rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19419 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19420 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19421 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19422 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019424 ACL derivatives :
19425 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019426
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019427req.ssl_alpn : string
19428 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19429 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19430 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19431 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19432 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19433 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019434 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019435
19436 Examples :
19437 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19438 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19439 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019440 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019441 default_backend bk_default
19442
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019443req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19444 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19445 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019446 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19447 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19448 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19449 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19450 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019452req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19453req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19454 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19455 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19456 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19457 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19458 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19459 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19460 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019462req.ssl_sni : string
19463req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19464 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19465 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19466 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19467 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19468 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019469 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19470 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19471 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19472 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19473 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19474 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19475 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19476 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19477 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019479 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019480 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019482 Examples :
19483 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19484 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19485 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019486 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019487 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019488
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019489req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19490 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19491 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19492 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19493 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19494 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19495 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19496 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19497 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19498 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019500req.ssl_ver : integer
19501req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19502 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19503 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19504 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19505 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19506 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19507 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19508 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019509 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019510 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019512 ACL derivatives :
19513 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019514
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019515res.len : integer
19516 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19517 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19518 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19519 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19520 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019521 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019522 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019523 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019525res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19526 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019527 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019528 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019529 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019530 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019532res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19533 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19534 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19535 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019536 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19537 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019539 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019540
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019541res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19542rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19543 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19544 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19545 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19546 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19547 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19548 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19549 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019551wait_end : boolean
19552 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19553 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019554 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019555 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19556 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019557 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019558 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19559 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019561 Examples :
19562 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19563 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19564 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019566 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19567 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19568 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19569 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19570 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19571 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19572 tcp-request content reject
19573
19574
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200195757.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019576--------------------------------------
19577
19578It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19579This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19580data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19581its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19582HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19583content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19584to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19585more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19586response are indexed.
19587
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019588Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19589 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19590 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19591 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19592 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19593 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19594 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019596base : string
19597 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19598 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19599 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19600 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19601 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19602 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19603 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19604 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19605
19606 ACL derivatives :
19607 base : exact string match
19608 base_beg : prefix match
19609 base_dir : subdir match
19610 base_dom : domain match
19611 base_end : suffix match
19612 base_len : length match
19613 base_reg : regex match
19614 base_sub : substring match
19615
19616base32 : integer
19617 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19618 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19619 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019620 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19621 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19622 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019623
19624base32+src : binary
19625 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19626 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19627 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19628 per-URL counters.
19629
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019630baseq : string
19631 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19632 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19633 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19634 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19635
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019636capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19637 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19638 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19639 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19640
19641capture.req.method : string
19642 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19643 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19644 because it's allocated.
19645
19646capture.req.uri : string
19647 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19648 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19649 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19650 allocated.
19651
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019652capture.req.ver : string
19653 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19654 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19655 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19656
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019657capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19658 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19659 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19660 The first entry is an index of 0.
19661 See also: "capture response header"
19662
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019663capture.res.ver : string
19664 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19665 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19666 persistent flag.
19667
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019668req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019669 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19670 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19671 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019672
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019673req.body_param([<name>) : string
19674 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19675 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19676 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19677 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19678 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19679 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19680 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19681 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19682 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19683 given.
19684
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019685req.body_len : integer
19686 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19687 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019688 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19689 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019690
19691req.body_size : integer
19692 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019693 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19694 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019696req.cook([<name>]) : string
19697cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19698 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19699 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19700 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19701 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19702 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19703 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19704 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19705 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19706
19707 ACL derivatives :
19708 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19709 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19710 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19711 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19712 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19713 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19714 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19715 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019717req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19718cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19719 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19720 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019722req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19723cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19724 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19725 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19726 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19727 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019729cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19730 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19731 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19732 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19733 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019734 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019735 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19736 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19737 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19738 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019740hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19741 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19742 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19743 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19744 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019745 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019747req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019748 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19749 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19750 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19751 with headers such as User-Agent.
19752
19753 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19754 found.
19755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019756 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19757 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19758 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019759 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019761req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19762 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19763 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019764 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19765 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019767req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019768 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19769 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19770 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19771 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19772 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19773 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19774 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19775
19776 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19777 found.
19778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019779 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19780 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19781 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019782 with -1 being the last one.
19783
19784 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19785 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019787 ACL derivatives :
19788 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19789 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19790 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19791 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19792 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19793 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19794 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19795 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19796
19797req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19798hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19799 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19800 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019801 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19802 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19803 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19804
19805 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19806 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19807 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19808
19809 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019810
19811req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19812hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19813 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19814 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19815 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019816 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19817 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19818 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19819 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19820 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019821
19822 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19823
19824 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019825
19826req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19827hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19828 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19829 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19830 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019831
19832 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19833
19834 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019835
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019836req.hdrs : string
19837 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19838 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19839 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19840 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19841
19842req.hdrs_bin : binary
19843 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19844 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19845 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19846 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19847 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19848 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19849
19850 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019851
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019852 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19853 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019855http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19856 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19857 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19858 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19859 basic auth is supported.
19860
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019861http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19862 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19863 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19864 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19865 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019866 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19867 basic auth is supported.
19868
19869 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019870 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19871 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19872 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19873 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019874
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019875http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019876 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19877 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19878 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019879
19880http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019881 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19882 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19883 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019884
19885http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019886 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19887 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19888 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019890http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019891 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19892 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019893 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19894 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019896method : integer + string
19897 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19898 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19899 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19900 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19901 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19902 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19903 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019905 ACL derivatives :
19906 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019908 Example :
19909 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19910 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19911 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019913path : string
19914 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19915 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19916 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19917 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19918 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019919 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019920 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019922 ACL derivatives :
19923 path : exact string match
19924 path_beg : prefix match
19925 path_dir : subdir match
19926 path_dom : domain match
19927 path_end : suffix match
19928 path_len : length match
19929 path_reg : regex match
19930 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019931
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019932pathq : string
19933 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19934 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19935 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19936 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19937 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19938 result in both cases.
19939
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019940query : string
19941 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19942 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19943 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19944 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019945 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019946 which stops before the question mark.
19947
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019948req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19949 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19950 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19951 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19952 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019954req.ver : string
19955req_ver : string (deprecated)
19956 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19957 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19958 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019960 ACL derivatives :
19961 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019962
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019963res.body : binary
19964 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19965 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019966 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19967
19968 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019969
19970res.body_len : integer
19971 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19972 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019973 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19974
19975 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019976
19977res.body_size : integer
19978 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19979 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19980 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19981 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019982 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19983
19984 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019985
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019986res.cache_hit : boolean
19987 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19988 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19989
19990res.cache_name : string
19991 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19992 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19993 empty string.
19994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019995res.comp : boolean
19996 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19997 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19998 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020000res.comp_algo : string
20001 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
20002 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
20003 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020005res.cook([<name>]) : string
20006scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20007 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20008 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020009 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20010
20011 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020013 ACL derivatives :
20014 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020016res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20017scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20018 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20019 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020020 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
20021
20022 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020024res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20025scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20026 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20027 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020028 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20029
20030 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020032res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020033 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20034 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20035
20036 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
20037 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
20038
20039 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
20040
20041 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020043res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020044 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20045 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20046
20047 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
20048 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
20049
20050 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020052res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20053shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020054 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20055 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20056
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020057 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020058 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
20059
20060 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020062 ACL derivatives :
20063 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20064 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20065 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20066 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20067 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20068 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20069 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20070 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20071
20072res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20073shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020074 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20075 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20076
20077 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020078 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020079
20080 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020082res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20083shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020084 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
20085 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20086
20087 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20088
20089 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020090
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020091res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20092 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20093 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20094 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020095 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20096
20097 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020099res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20100shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020101 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
20102 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20103
20104 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20105
20106 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020107
20108res.hdrs : string
20109 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
20110 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20111 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020112 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20113
20114 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020115
20116res.hdrs_bin : binary
20117 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20118 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
20119 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
20120 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
20121 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
20122 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
20123 (length of 0 for both).
20124
20125 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
20126
20127 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20128 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020130res.ver : string
20131resp_ver : string (deprecated)
20132 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020133 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
20134
20135 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020137 ACL derivatives :
20138 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020140set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20141 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20142 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020143 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020144 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020146 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
20147 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020149status : integer
20150 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
20151 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020152 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
20153
20154 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020155
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020020156unique-id : string
20157 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
20158 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
20159 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
20160 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
20161 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
20162 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
20163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020164url : string
20165 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
20166 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
20167 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
20168 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
20169 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
20170 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
20171 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020173 ACL derivatives :
20174 url : exact string match
20175 url_beg : prefix match
20176 url_dir : subdir match
20177 url_dom : domain match
20178 url_end : suffix match
20179 url_len : length match
20180 url_reg : regex match
20181 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020183url_ip : ip
20184 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
20185 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
20186 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
20187 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020188 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
20189 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020191url_port : integer
20192 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020193 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020194
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020195urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
20196url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020197 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
20198 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020199 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
20200 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
20201 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
20202 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020203 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20204 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020205 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20206 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020208 ACL derivatives :
20209 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20210 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20211 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20212 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20213 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20214 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20215 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20216 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020217
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020219 Example :
20220 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20221 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20222 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20223 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020224
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020225urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020226 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20227 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20228 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020229
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020230url32 : integer
20231 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20232 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20233 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20234 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20235 is an unsigned integer.
20236
20237url32+src : binary
20238 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20239 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20240 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20241
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020242
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200202437.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020244---------------------------------------
20245
20246This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20247used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20248purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20249There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20250or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20251any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20252for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20253
20254internal.htx.data : integer
20255 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20256 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20257
20258internal.htx.free : integer
20259 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20260 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20261
20262internal.htx.free_data : integer
20263 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20264 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20265
20266internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020267 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20268 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20269 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020270
20271internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20272 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20273 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20274
20275internal.htx.size : integer
20276 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20277 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20278
20279internal.htx.used : integer
20280 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20281 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20282 direction.
20283
20284internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20285 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20286 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20287 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20288 of the special value :
20289 * head : The oldest inserted block
20290 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020291 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020292
20293internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20294 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20295 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20296 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20297 integer or one of the special value :
20298 * head : The oldest inserted block
20299 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020300 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020301
20302internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20303 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20304 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20305 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20306 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20307
20308 * head : The oldest inserted block
20309 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020310 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020311
20312internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20313 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20314 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20315 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20316 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20317
20318 * head : The oldest inserted block
20319 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020320 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020321
20322internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20323 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20324 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20325 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20326 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20327
20328 * head : The oldest inserted block
20329 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020330 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020331
20332internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20333 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20334 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20335 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20336 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20337
20338 * head : The oldest inserted block
20339 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020340 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020341
20342internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20343 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20344 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20345 it returns false.
20346
20347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200203487.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020349---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020351Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20352every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020353order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020355ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020356---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20357FALSE always_false never match
20358HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20359HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20360HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020361HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020362HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20363HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20364HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20365HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20366LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20367METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20368METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20369METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20370METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20371METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20372METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20373METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20374METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20375RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20376REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20377TRUE always_true always match
20378WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20379---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020380
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203828. Logging
20383----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020384
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020385One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20386provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20387very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20388provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20389state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020390to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020391headers.
20392
20393In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20394about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20395send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20396
20397 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20398 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20399 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20400 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20401 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020402 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020403 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020404
20405The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20406allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20407as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20408while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20409real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20410delay.
20411
20412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204138.1. Log levels
20414---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020415
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020416TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020417source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020418HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20419in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20420track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20421syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20422about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020423
20424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204258.2. Log formats
20426----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020427
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020428HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020429and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20430slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20431options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020432
20433 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20434 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20435 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20436 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20437 extents.
20438
20439 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20440 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20441 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20442 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20443 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20444
20445 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20446 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20447 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20448 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20449 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20450
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020451 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20452 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20453 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20454 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20455
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020456 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20457
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020458Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20459specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20460field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20461servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20462always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20463identifier.
20464
20465Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20466 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20467 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20468 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20469 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20470
20471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204728.2.1. Default log format
20473-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020474
20475This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20476as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20477format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20478
20479 Example :
20480 listen www
20481 mode http
20482 log global
20483 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20484
20485 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20486 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20487 (www/HTTP)
20488
20489 Field Format Extract from the example above
20490 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20491 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20492 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20493 4 'to' to
20494 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20495 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20496
20497Detailed fields description :
20498 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20499 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20500 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20501 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20502 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20503 and processed the connection.
20504 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20505
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020506In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20507"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20508connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20509
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020510It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20511will eventually disappear.
20512
20513
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205148.2.2. TCP log format
20515---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020516
20517The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20518is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20519information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20520counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20521emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20522environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20523the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20524sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020525specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20526not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20527fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20528marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020529
20530 Example :
20531 frontend fnt
20532 mode tcp
20533 option tcplog
20534 log global
20535 default_backend bck
20536
20537 backend bck
20538 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20539
20540 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20541 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20542 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20543
20544 Field Format Extract from the example above
20545 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20546 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20547 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20548 4 frontend_name fnt
20549 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20550 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20551 7 bytes_read* 212
20552 8 termination_state --
20553 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20554 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20555
20556Detailed fields description :
20557 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020558 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020559 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20560 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020561 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020562 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020563 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020564
20565 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020566 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20567 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20568 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020569
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020570 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020571 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20572 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020573 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20574 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20575 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20576 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020577
20578 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20579 and processed the connection.
20580
20581 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20582 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20583 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20584 applications.
20585
20586 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20587 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20588 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20589 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20590 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20591
20592 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20593 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20594 See "Timers" below for more details.
20595
20596 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20597 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20598 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20599 "Timers" below for more details.
20600
20601 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020602 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020603 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20604 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20605 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20606 details.
20607
20608 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20609 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20610 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20611 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20612 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20613
20614 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20615 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20616 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20617 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20618 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20619 for more details.
20620
20621 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020622 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020623 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20624 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20625 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020626 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020627
20628 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20629 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20630 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20631 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20632 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20633 caused by a denial of service attack.
20634
20635 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20636 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20637 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20638 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20639 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20640 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20641 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20642 denial of service attack.
20643
20644 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20645 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20646 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20647 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20648 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20649 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20650 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20651 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20652 be processed than on other servers.
20653
20654 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20655 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20656 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20657 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020658 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020659 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20660 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20661 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20662 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20663 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20664 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20665 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20666 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20667
20668 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20669 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20670 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20671 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20672 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20673 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020674 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020675 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20676
20677 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20678 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20679 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20680 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20681 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20682 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020683 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020684 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20685 occurs.
20686
20687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206888.2.3. HTTP log format
20689----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020690
20691The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20692is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20693the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20694are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20695emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20696generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20697"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20698which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020699frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20700is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020701
20702Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20703slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20704with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20705
20706 Example :
20707 frontend http-in
20708 mode http
20709 option httplog
20710 log global
20711 default_backend bck
20712
20713 backend static
20714 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20715
20716 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20717 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20718 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020719 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020720
20721 Field Format Extract from the example above
20722 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20723 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020724 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020725 4 frontend_name http-in
20726 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020727 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020728 7 status_code 200
20729 8 bytes_read* 2750
20730 9 captured_request_cookie -
20731 10 captured_response_cookie -
20732 11 termination_state ----
20733 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20734 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20735 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20736 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20737 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020738
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020739Detailed fields description :
20740 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020741 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020742 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20743 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020744 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020745 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020746 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020747
20748 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020749 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20750 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20751 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020752
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020753 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020754 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020755
20756 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20757 and processed the connection.
20758
20759 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20760 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20761 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20762
20763 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20764 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20765 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20766 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20767 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20768 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20769
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020770 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20771 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20772 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020773 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020774 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20775 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020776 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020777 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020778
20779 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20780 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020781 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020782
20783 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20784 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020785 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20786 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020787
20788 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20789 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20790 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20791 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20792 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020793 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20794 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020795
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020796 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020797 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20798 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20799 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20800 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20801 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20802 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020803 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020804
20805 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020806 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20807 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020808
20809 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20810 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020811 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020812 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20813 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20814 overflowing.
20815
20816 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20817 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20818 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20819 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20820 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20821 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20822 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20823 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20824
20825 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20826 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20827 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20828 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20829 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20830 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20831 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20832 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20833
20834 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20835 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20836 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20837 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20838 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20839 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20840 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20841
20842 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020843 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020844 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20845 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20846 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020847 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020848 system.
20849
20850 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20851 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20852 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20853 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20854 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20855 caused by a denial of service attack.
20856
20857 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20858 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20859 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20860 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20861 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20862 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20863 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20864 denial of service attack.
20865
20866 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20867 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20868 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20869 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20870 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20871 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20872 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20873 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20874 processed than on other servers.
20875
20876 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20877 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20878 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20879 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020880 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020881 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20882 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20883 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20884 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20885 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20886 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20887 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20888 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20889
20890 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20891 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20892 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20893 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20894 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20895 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020896 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020897 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20898
20899 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20900 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20901 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20902 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20903 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20904 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020905 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020906 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20907 occurs.
20908
20909 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20910 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20911 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20912 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20913 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20914 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20915 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20916 cookies" below for more details.
20917
20918 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20919 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20920 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20921 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20922 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20923 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20924 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20925 and cookies" below for more details.
20926
20927 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20928 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20929 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20930 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20931 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20932 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20933 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20934 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20935
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020936
209378.2.4. HTTPS log format
20938----------------------
20939
20940The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
20941extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
20942information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
20943frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
20944end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
20945matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
20946sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
20947dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
20948"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
20949
20950This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
20951appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
20952HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020953
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020954 Example :
20955 frontend https-in
20956 mode http
20957 option httpslog
20958 log global
20959 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
20960 default_backend bck
20961
20962 backend static
20963 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
20964
20965 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20966 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
20967 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
20968 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0 TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
20969
20970 Field Format Extract from the example above
20971 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20972 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
20973 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
20974 4 frontend_name https-in
20975 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
20976 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
20977 7 status_code 200
20978 8 bytes_read* 2750
20979 9 captured_request_cookie -
20980 10 captured_response_cookie -
20981 11 termination_state ----
20982 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20983 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20984 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20985 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20986 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
William Lallemandfdc3faf2021-08-02 10:57:49 +020020987 17 fc_conn_err '/' ssl_fc_hsk_err '/' ssl_c_err '/' ssl_c_ca_err 0/0/0/0
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020988 18 ssl_version '/' ssl_ciphers TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
20989
20990Detailed fields description :
William Lallemandfdc3faf2021-08-02 10:57:49 +020020991 - "fc_conn_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020020992 corresponds to the "fc_conn_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_conn_err" and
20993 "fc_conn_err_str" fetches for more information.
20994
20995 - "ssl_fc_hsk_err" is the status of the SSL handshake from the frontend's
20996 point of view. It will be 0 if everything went well. See the
20997 "ssl_fc_hsk_err" sample fetch's description for more information.
20998
20999 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
21000 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
21001 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
21002 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
21003
21004 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
21005 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
21006 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
21007 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
21008
21009 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
21010
21011 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
21012
21013
210148.2.5. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021015------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021016
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021017The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021018mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021019
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021020HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021021Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
21022separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
21023prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
21024
21025Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
21026variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021027("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021028
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021029If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020021030as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021031less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
21032the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
21033
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020021034Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
21035"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
21036delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
21037preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021038
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021039Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
21040'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
21041https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
21042such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
21043
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021044Flags are :
21045 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021046 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021047 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
21048 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021049
21050 Example:
21051
21052 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
21053 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
21054
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021055 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
21056
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021057At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
21058
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021059 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21060 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021061
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021062the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021063
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021064 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
21065 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
21066 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021067
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021068the default HTTPS format is defined this way :
21069
21070 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21071 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
21072 %[fc_conn_err]/%[ssl_fc_hsk_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err] \
21073 %sslv/%sslc"
21074
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021075and the default TCP format is defined this way :
21076
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021077 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
21078 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021079
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021080Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
21081
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021082 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021083 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021084 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
21085 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
21086 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021087 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
21088 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
21089 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021090 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021091 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000021092 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000021093 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000021094 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021095 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
21096 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010021097 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020021098 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021099 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021100 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021101 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020021102 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080021103 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021104 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
21105 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
21106 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
21107 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
21108 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021109 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021110 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021111 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021112 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021113 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021114 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
21115 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021116 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21117 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
21118 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021119 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021120 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
21121 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021122 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021123 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21124 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
21125 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020021126 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020021127 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021128 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
21129 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
21130 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
21131 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020021132 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021133 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021134 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021135 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010021136 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021137 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021138 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
21139 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
21140 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021141 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021142 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
21143 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021144 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021145 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
21146 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020021147 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021148 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021149 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021150 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021151
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021152 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021153
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021154
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +0200211558.2.6. Error log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021156-----------------------
21157
21158When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +020021159protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
21160unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
21161line. In the latter case, the legacy log format described below will not be
21162used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the defined format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021163By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
21164"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021165will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +020021166logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021167
21168The format looks like this :
21169
21170 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
21171 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
21172 Connection error during SSL handshake
21173
21174 Field Format Extract from the example above
21175 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
21176 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
21177 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
21178 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
21179 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
21180
21181These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
21182failures.
21183
21184
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211858.3. Advanced logging options
21186-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021187
21188Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
21189just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
21190options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
21191for more information about their usage.
21192
21193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211948.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
21195------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021196
21197It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021198HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021199commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
21200monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
21201ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
21202
21203 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
21204 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
21205 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
21206 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
21207
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020021208 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
21209 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021210
21211 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
21212 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
21213 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
21214
21215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212168.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
21217----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021218
21219The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
21220what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
21221or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021222"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021223just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
21224log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
21225after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
21226is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
21227with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
21228with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
21229
21230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212318.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
21232------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021233
21234Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
21235for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
21236"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
21237retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
21238raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
21239a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
21240file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
21241you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
21242"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
21243
21244
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212458.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
21246--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021247
21248Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
21249multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
21250them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
21251"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
21252logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
21253error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
21254and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
21255too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
21256useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
21257alternative.
21258
21259
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212608.4. Timing events
21261------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021262
21263Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
21264reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
21265the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
21266frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021267mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
21268addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
21269
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021270Timings events in HTTP mode:
21271
21272 first request 2nd request
21273 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
21274 t tr t tr ...
21275 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
21276 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
21277 :<---- Tq ---->: :
21278 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021279 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021280 :<--------- Ta --------->:
21281
21282Timings events in TCP mode:
21283
21284 TCP session
21285 |<----------------->|
21286 t t
21287 ---|----|----|----|----|---
21288 | Th Tw Tc Td |
21289 |<------ Tt ------->|
21290
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021291 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021292 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021293 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
21294 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
21295 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021296 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021297 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
21298 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
21299 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
21300 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021301
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021302 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
21303 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
21304 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021305 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
21306 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
21307 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21308 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21309 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21310 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021311
21312 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21313 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21314 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21315 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21316 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21317 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21318 request typed by hand during a test.
21319
21320 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21321 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021322 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021323 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21324 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21325 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21326 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021327
21328 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21329 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21330 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21331 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21332 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21333
21334 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21335 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21336 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21337 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21338 connection never established.
21339
21340 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21341 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21342 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21343 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21344 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21345 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21346 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21347 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21348 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21349 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21350 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21351
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021352 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21353 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21354 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21355 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21356 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21357 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21358
21359 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21360
21361 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21362 "Ta" can never be negative.
21363
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021364 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21365 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021366 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21367 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021368 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021369
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021370 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021371
21372 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021373 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21374 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021375
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021376 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21377 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21378 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21379 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21380 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21381 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21382 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21383 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21384
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021385These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21386protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21387that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021388due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21389"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21390that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021391
21392Most common cases :
21393
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021394 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21395 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21396 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21397 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21398 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021399 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021400 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21401 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21402 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21403 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21404 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021405 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021406
21407 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21408 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21409 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21410 of ms on remote networks.
21411
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021412 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21413 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21414 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021415
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021416 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21417 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021418 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021419 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21420 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21421 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21422 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21423 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21424 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021425
21426Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21427
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021428 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021429 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021430 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021431
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021432 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021433 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21434 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21435
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021436 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021437 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21438 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21439 flags.
21440
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021441 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21442 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021443 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21444 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21445 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21446 the client connection was maintained open.
21447
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021448 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021449 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021450 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021451 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21452
21453
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214548.5. Session state at disconnection
21455-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021456
21457TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21458"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
214592-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21460each of which has a special meaning :
21461
21462 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21463 session to terminate :
21464
21465 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21466
21467 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21468 server explicitly refused it.
21469
21470 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21471 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21472 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21473 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021474 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021475
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021476 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021477 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021478
21479 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21480 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21481 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21482 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21483 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21484
21485 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21486 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21487 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21488 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21489 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21490
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021491 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021492 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21493
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021494 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021495 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21496 backup connections when going up.
21497
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021498 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021499
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021500 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21501 send or receive data.
21502
21503 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21504 send or receive data.
21505
21506 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21507 with nothing left in the buffers.
21508
21509 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21510
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021511 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021512 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21513
21514 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21515 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21516 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21517 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21518 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21519
21520 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21521 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21522
21523 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21524 server (HTTP only).
21525
21526 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21527
21528 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21529 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21530 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21531
21532 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21533 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21534 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21535
21536 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21537
21538 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21539 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21540
21541 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21542 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21543 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21544
21545 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21546 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021547 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21548 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021549
21550 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21551 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21552 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21553 another server.
21554
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021555 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021556 server.
21557
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021558 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21559 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21560 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21561 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21562
21563 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21564 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21565 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21566 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21567
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021568 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21569 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21570 "use-server" rule).
21571
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021572 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21573
21574 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21575 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21576
21577 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21578
21579 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21580 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21581 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21582
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021583 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21584 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021585 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021586 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21587 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21588
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021589 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21590
21591 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21592 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21593
21594 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21595
21596 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21597
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021598The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21599was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021600helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21601starvation, attacks, etc...
21602
21603The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21604alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21605easier finding and understanding.
21606
21607 Flags Reason
21608
21609 -- Normal termination.
21610
21611 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021612 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21613 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021614 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21615
21616 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21617 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021618 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21619 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021620 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21621 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021622
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021623 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21624 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021625 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021626
21627 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21628 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21629 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21630
21631 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21632 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21633 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21634 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21635 the server takes too long to respond.
21636
21637 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21638 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21639 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21640 long a time to respond.
21641
21642 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21643 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21644 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021645 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021646 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21647 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021648
21649 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21650 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21651 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21652 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21653 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021654 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021655 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21656 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21657 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21658 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21659 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21660 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21661 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21662 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021663 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021664 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21665 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21666 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021667
21668 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21669 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021670 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21671 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21672 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21673 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021674
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021675 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021676 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21677
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021678 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021679 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21680 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021681 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021682 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21683 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21684
21685 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21686 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21687 503 or 504 here.
21688
21689 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021690 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021691 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21692 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21693 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21694
21695 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21696 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021697 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021698 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021699 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021700
21701 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21702 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21703 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21704 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21705 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21706 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021707 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021708
21709 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21710 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21711 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21712 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21713 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21714 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21715 solution is to fix the application.
21716
21717 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21718 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21719 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21720 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21721 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21722 external attacks.
21723
21724 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021725 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021726 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021727 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21728 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21729
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021730 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21731 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21732 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021733 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021734 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021735
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021736 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21737 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21738 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21739 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021740 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21741 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21742 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21743 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21744 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021745
21746 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21747 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21748 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21749 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21750
21751 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21752 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21753 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21754 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21755
21756 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21757 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21758 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21759 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21760
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021761The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021762persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021763important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21764re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21765
21766 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21767
21768 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21769 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21770 set on a GET request.
21771
21772 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21773 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021774 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021775 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21776
21777 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21778 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21779 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21780
21781 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21782 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21783 already got a cookie.
21784
21785 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21786 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21787 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21788 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21789 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21790
21791 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21792 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21793 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21794
21795 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21796 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21797 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21798
21799 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21800 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21801
21802 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21803 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21804 then advertised in the response.
21805
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218078.6. Non-printable characters
21808-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021809
21810In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21811consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21812converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21813prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21814being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21815escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21816is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21817'}' when logging headers.
21818
21819Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21820issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21821containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21822
21823Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21824the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21825performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21826
21827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218288.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21829---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021830
21831Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21832achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021833section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021834cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21835the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21836the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021837locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021838not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21839user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21840a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21841wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21842
21843 Examples :
21844 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21845 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21846
21847 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21848 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21849
21850
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218518.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21852---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021853
21854Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21855proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21856the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21857server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21858
21859Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21860response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021861section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021862
21863It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021864time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21865appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021866are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21867and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21868follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21869request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21870in the logs.
21871
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021872As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21873frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21874an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21875
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021876 Example :
21877 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21878 listen proxy-out
21879 mode http
21880 option httplog
21881 option logasap
21882 log global
21883 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21884
21885 # log the name of the virtual server
21886 capture request header Host len 20
21887
21888 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21889 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21890
21891 # log the beginning of the referrer
21892 capture request header Referer len 20
21893
21894 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21895 capture response header Server len 20
21896
21897 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21898 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21899
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021900 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021901 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21902
21903 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21904 capture response header Via len 20
21905
21906 # log the URL location during a redirection
21907 capture response header Location len 20
21908
21909 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21910 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21911 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21912 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21913 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21914
21915 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21916 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21917 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21918 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021919 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021920
21921 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21922 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21923 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21924 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21925 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021926 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021927
21928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219298.9. Examples of logs
21930---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021931
21932These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21933them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21934reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21935
21936 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21937 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21938 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21939
21940 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21941 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21942
21943 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21944 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21945 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21946
21947 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21948 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21949
21950 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21951 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21952 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21953
21954 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021955 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021956 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21957 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21958
21959 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21960 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21961 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21962
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021963 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21964 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21965 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21966 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021967 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021968 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021969
21970 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021971 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021972
21973 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21974 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21975 Nothing was sent to any server.
21976
21977 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21978 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21979
21980 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21981 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021982 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021983 send a 408 return code to the client.
21984
21985 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21986 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21987
21988 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21989 5 seconds ("c----").
21990
21991 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21992 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021993 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021994
21995 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021996 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021997 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21998 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21999 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
22000 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
22001 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022002
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020022003
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200220049. Supported filters
22005--------------------
22006
22007Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
22008accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
22009unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
22010
22011See also : "filter"
22012
220139.1. Trace
22014----------
22015
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010022016filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022017
22018 Arguments:
22019 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
22020 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
22021
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010022022 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022023
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022024 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022025 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
22026 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
22027 amount of the parsed data.
22028
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022029 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010022030
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022031This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
22032callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
22033information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
22034filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
22035
22036Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
22037tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
22038a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
22039
22040
220419.2. HTTP compression
22042---------------------
22043
22044filter compression
22045
22046The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
22047keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022048when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
22049fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
22050done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
22051explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
22052filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
22053listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22054order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022055
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022056See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
22057 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022058
22059
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200220609.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
22061--------------------------------------------
22062
22063filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
22064
22065 Arguments :
22066
22067 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
22068 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
22069 parsed.
22070
22071 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
22072 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
22073 part must be placed in its own scope.
22074
22075The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
22076external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022077streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022078exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
22079also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
22080
22081SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
22082the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
22083
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022084For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022085"doc/SPOE.txt".
22086
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100220879.4. Cache
22088----------
22089
22090filter cache <name>
22091
22092 Arguments :
22093
22094 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
22095
22096The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
22097"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022098cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022099other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
22100case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
22101is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
22102filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010022103listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22104order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010022105
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022106See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
22107 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
22108
22109
221109.5. Fcgi-app
22111-------------
22112
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022113filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022114
22115 Arguments :
22116
22117 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
22118
22119The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
22120request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
22121reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
22122used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
22123implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
22124used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
22125fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
22126used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22127order.
22128
22129See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
22130 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
22131
22132
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100221339.6. OpenTracing
22134----------------
22135
22136The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
22137HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
22138of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
22139Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
22140
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022141This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022142
22143The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
22144HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
22145participates in the work of HAProxy.
22146
22147filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
22148
22149 Arguments :
22150
22151 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
22152 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
22153 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
22154 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
22155 OpenTracing filters.
22156
22157 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
22158 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
22159 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
22160 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
22161 filter must have its own scope defined.
22162
22163More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020022164of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022165
22166
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002216710. FastCGI applications
22168-------------------------
22169
22170HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
22171feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
22172the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
22173FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
22174servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
22175FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
22176backend.
22177
22178HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
22179application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
22180connection.
22181
2218210.1. Setup
22183-----------
22184
2218510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
22186--------------------------
22187
22188fcgi-app <name>
22189 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
22190 document root must be defined.
22191
22192acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
22193 Declare or complete an access list.
22194
22195 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
22196 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
22197 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
22198 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
22199 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
22200
22201docroot <path>
22202 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
22203 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
22204 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
22205
22206index <script-name>
22207 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
22208 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
22209 is an optional setting.
22210
22211 Example :
22212 index index.php
22213
22214log-stderr global
22215log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010022216 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022217 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
22218
22219 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
22220 default STDERR messages are ignored.
22221
22222pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22223 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
22224 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
22225 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22226
22227 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
22228 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
22229 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
22230 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
22231
22232 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
22233 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
22234
22235path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022236 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022237 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
22238 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
22239 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
22240 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
22241 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
22242 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
22243 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022244
22245 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022246 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022247 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
22248 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
22249 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
22250 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022251
22252 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022253 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
22254 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022255
22256option get-values
22257no option get-values
22258 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
22259
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022260 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022261 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
22262
22263 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
22264 application will accept.
22265
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020022266 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
22267 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022268
22269 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050022270 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022271 option is disabled.
22272
22273 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
22274 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
22275 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
22276 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
22277 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
22278 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
22279
22280option keep-conn
22281no option keep-conn
22282 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
22283 sending a response.
22284
22285 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
22286 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
22287
22288option max-reqs <reqs>
22289 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
22290 accept.
22291
22292 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
22293 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
22294 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
22295 to 1.
22296
22297option mpxs-conns
22298no option mpxs-conns
22299 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
22300
22301 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22302 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22303
22304set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22305 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22306 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22307 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22308 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22309
22310 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22311 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22312 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22313
22314 Example :
22315 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22316 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22317
22318 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22319
22320
2232110.1.2. Proxy section
22322---------------------
22323
22324use-fcgi-app <name>
22325 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22326
22327 Arguments :
22328 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22329
22330 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22331 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22332 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22333 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22334 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22335
22336 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22337 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22338 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22339 application are evaluated.
22340
22341
2234210.1.3. Example
22343---------------
22344
22345 frontend front-http
22346 mode http
22347 bind *:80
22348 bind *:
22349
22350 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22351 default_backend back-static
22352
22353 backend back-static
22354 mode http
22355 server www A.B.C.D:80
22356
22357 backend back-dynamic
22358 mode http
22359 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22360 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22361
22362 fcgi-app php-fpm
22363 log-stderr global
22364 option keep-conn
22365
22366 docroot /var/www/my-app
22367 index index.php
22368 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22369
22370
2237110.2. Default parameters
22372------------------------
22373
22374A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22375the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022376script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022377applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22378
22379 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22380 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22381 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22382 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22383 | | |
22384 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22385 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22386 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22387 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22388 | | application. |
22389 | | |
22390 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22391 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22392 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22393 | | |
22394 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22395 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22396 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22397 | | the application's configuration. |
22398 | | |
22399 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22400 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22401 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22402 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22403 | | |
22404 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22405 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22406 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22407 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22408 | | be defined. |
22409 | | |
22410 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22411 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22412 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22413 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22414 | | is not set too. |
22415 | | |
22416 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22417 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22418 | | set. |
22419 | | |
22420 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22421 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22422 | | the request. |
22423 | | |
22424 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22425 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22426 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22427 | | |
22428 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22429 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22430 | | script to process the request. |
22431 | | |
22432 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22433 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22434 | | |
22435 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22436 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22437 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22438 | | |
22439 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22440 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22441 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22442 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22443 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22444 | | |
22445 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22446 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22447 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22448 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22449 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22450 | | side. |
22451 | | |
22452 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22453 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22454 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22455 | | connected to. |
22456 | | |
22457 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22458 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22459 | | |
22460 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022461 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22462 | | current HAProxy version. |
22463 | | |
22464 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022465 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22466 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22467 | | |
22468 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22469
22470
2247110.3. Limitations
22472------------------
22473
22474The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22475way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22476during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22477establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22478application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22479or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22480message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22481these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22482and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22483
22484Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22485request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22486requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22487
22488About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22489into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22490fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22491"http-request" ones.
22492
22493Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22494FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22495processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22496must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22497here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022498
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022499
2250011. Address formats
22501-------------------
22502
22503Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22504address.
22505
22506This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22507The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22508of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22509equivalent is '::'.
22510
22511Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22512is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22513
22514This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22515family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22516
22517Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22518configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22519use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22520'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22521
22522Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22523socket type and the transport method.
22524
22525
2252611.1 Address family prefixes
22527----------------------------
22528
22529'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22530
22531'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22532 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22533 listening.
22534
22535'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22536 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22537 on the statement using this address, a port or
22538 a port range may or must be specified.
22539
22540'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22541 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22542 using this address, a port or a port range
22543 may or must be specified.
22544
22545'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22546 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22547 using this address, a port or a port range
22548 may or must be specified.
22549
22550'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22551 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22552 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22553 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22554 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22555 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22556
22557'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22558 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22559 start by slash '/'.
22560
22561
2256211.2 Socket type prefixes
22563-------------------------
22564
22565Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22566type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22567this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22568This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22569but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22570
22571Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22572instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22573
22574If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22575they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22576report this to the maintainers.
22577
22578'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22579 to "stream"
22580
22581'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22582 to "datagram".
22583
22584
2258511.3 Protocol prefixes
22586----------------------
22587
22588'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22589 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22590 socket type and transport method is forced to
22591 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22592 this address, a port or a port range can or
22593 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22594 of 'stream+ip@'.
22595
22596'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22597 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22598 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22599 statement using this address, a port or port
22600 range can or must be specified.
22601 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22602
22603'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22604 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22605 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22606 statement using this address, a port or port
22607 range can or must be specified.
22608 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22609
22610'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22611 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22612 socket type and transport method is forced to
22613 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22614 this address, a port or a port range can or
22615 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22616 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22617
22618'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22619 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22620 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22621 the statement using this address, a port or
22622 port range can or must be specified.
22623 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22624
22625'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22626 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22627 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22628 the statement using this address, a port or
22629 port range can or must be specified.
22630 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22631
22632'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22633 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22634 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22635
22636'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22637 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22638 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22639
22640In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22641QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22642
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022643/*
22644 * Local variables:
22645 * fill-column: 79
22646 * End:
22647 */